Eng 101 Handouts PDF
Eng 101 Handouts PDF
Eng 101 Handouts PDF
ENG 101
Table of Contents
Page
Lecture No. Topic No.
Lecture No.01 Reading and Dictionary 4
Lecture No.02 Pronunciation 12
Lecture No.03 Reading for Main Idea 16
Lecture No.04 Reading: Topic, Main Idea 20
Lecture No.05 Reading: References 25
Lecture No.06 Reading Skills 30
Lecture No.07 Reading and Vocabulary 36
Lecture No.08 Word Formation- Prefixes 43
Lecture No.09 Reading: Description, Locating Information 51
Lecture No.10 Reading: Word Forms 59
Lecture No.11 Reading: Understanding Reading 66
Lecture No.12 Reading: Making Inferences 73
Lecture No.13 Reading: Assessing the Text 80
Lecture No.14 Reading: Assessing Texts 86
Lecture No.15 Evaluating Texts: Interpreting Visual Data 91
Lecture No.16 Reading: Evaluating Texts 102
Lecture No.17 Reading: Cloze for Comprehension 109
Lecture No.18 Reading: Skimming and Scanning 115
Lecture No.19 Reading: Scanning and Language Functions 122
Lecture No.20 Reading: Classifying, Cause and Effect Relationship 129
Lecture No.21 Reading: Presenting Information Graphically 137
Lecture No.22 Writing: Sentence Types 145
Lecture No.23 Writing: Effective Sentences: Unity, Coherence, Emphasis 153
Lecture No.24 WRITING: IDENTIFYING SENTENCE ERRORS 158
Lecture No.25 WRITING: REVISING SENTENCE ERRORS 163
Lecture No.26 Subject Verb Agreement 169
Lecture No.27 Writing 175
Lecture No.28 Word Choice 182
Lecture No.29 Punctuation 190
Lecture No.30 Writing: Paragraphs: Structural Parts 199
Lecture No.31 Writing: Paragraph 203
Lecture No.32 Writing: Paragraphs 209
Lecture No.33 Writing: Essay Writing 216
Lecture No.34 Essay writing 222
Lecture No.35 Writing: Essay Outlines 228
Lecture No.36 Writing: Selecting and Researching an Essay Topic 234
Lecture No.37 Writing: Ways of Organizing Texts: Linear 240
Lecture No.38 Writing: Ways of Organizing Texts 244
Lecture No.39 Writing: Ways of Organizing Texts 248
Lecture No.40 Writing Skills 252
Lecture No.41 Writing: Summary Writing 257
2
VU
Lecture No.42 Grammar and Usage: Tenses and Passive Sentences 261
Lecture No.43 Grammar and Usage: Word Order: Adverbs 268
Lecture No.44 Grammar and Usage: Articles 277
Lecture No.45 Language Functions: Language Forms and Functions 286
Lesson -01
This lesson is in two parts. In the first part, you will learn about the:
In the second part of the lesson, you will read an interesting story.
Definition of Dictionary
A dictionary is a book that not only lists and records the words of a language but it also tells you
how speakers of the language spell, pronounce, define, explain and use the words of their
language.
Reference Book - provides useful information. It is valuable only if you learn how to use it
correctly and efficiently.
(i) Spelling
(ii) Pronunciation
iii) Part of speech
iv) Origin of word
(v) Meaning/explanation
(vi) Usage/restrictive lables
(vii) Synonyms & antonyms
(viii) Foreign words & phrases
ix) General information.
i) Spelling
Many students find English spelling very confusing. So what do you do? Consult your
dictionary. It will clarify your confusion by showing you the different spellings of the
same word.
Look at the words catalogue and theatre. You must have noticed that the dictionary lists
both BRE and AE/US spelling of the words. Both are correct.
4
VU
(ii) Pronunciation
Students have problems in pronouncing English words. A dictionary will help you learn
the pronunciation of any word but only if you are familiar with the symbols in which they
are written. We will discuss this in greater detail in the next lesson.
Also look up words above and below the word that you are looking for. You will find
that words are often closely related. It will help to extend your recognition of the word in
other forms and contexts.
Exercise (v-a) Meaning:
Look up the words ‘fast’ and ‘set’ in a dictionary. Write the total number of different
meanings of each word. Include all the numbered and lettered meanings for each part of
speech.
Exercise (v-b):
Use the dictionary to find the specific meanings of the word ‘play’ in each of the
following:
A dictionary uses different labels like Br (British), Am (American), fml (formal), infml
(informal), col (colloquial), pl (plural), poetic (poetic), sl (slang).This information is
important in writing.
A dictionary will tell you the usage of words and phrases, idioms / proverbs of the
language. It will also tell you about the limitations of the use of the word. Special labels
are used to show this. If a word is no longer in current use it will be labelled archaic
(arch) or obsolete (obs). Other labels will tell you of the level of usage: whether the word
has literary flavour (poetic) or is slang (sl), formal (fml) informal (infml).
Look up the underlined words in the dictionary and write their meanings.
1. 1. Prof. Widdowson held forth for over an hour about the need for
communication language teaching.
2. 2. I don’t get how you found the answer.
3. My roommate is pretty hard up these days.
a) Look up the following words / phrases in the dictionary. Write whether its use is
primarily slang, informal or colloquial.
Guys Cool
Example:
6
VU
Step I: Know the correct order of the letters of the English alphabet.
all entries in dictionary are arranged in an alphabetical order.
words are arranged according to the 1st letter.
when the words begin with the same letter, they are arranged according to the
2nd letter.
if both the 1st and the 2nd letters are the same then the words are arranged
according to the 3rd letter, & so on...
Guide Words
B) Look at top of any page in the dictionary. The words in heavy type/bold face are the
GUIDE WORDS. They guide you to the word you are looking for.
- The word on the top left are same as the first bold face word on that page.
- Word on the top right of the page is the last bold face entry on that page.
RECAP
This concludes the first part of the lesson1. Now we move to the second part which, I hope you
will enjoy.
First we are going to show you the text of a story.You will read a folk tale from North America.
The story is about a natural event.
When the earth was very young, it was dark and old like a winter’s night through all the
year’s seasons. Gull was the Custodian of Daylight, and he kept it locked tight in a cedar box
beneath his wing. Being Custodian made Gull feel very important, and he was not going to lose
his position by letting Daylight out of the box.
“He is too vain!” screeched Owl, at a meeting of the People upon Meeting Hill.
“We can never travel, in this darkness, to our half-homes in this south,” cried Robin. Her
breast was bleached of colour for the lack of light.
Gull agreed to come to the meeting. But it was clear, when he came, that he was not going to
change his mind or listen to what Raven said. He had come only because it made him feel even
more important to have Raven pleading with him.
“I was made Custodian of Daylight in the beginning of things,” said Gull. “I am to keep
Daylight safe. And I will keep it safe.” And he curved his swing tighter around the cedar box.
Raven had run out of words to make Gull see the People’s need for light. He thought
angrily to himself, “I wish this Gull would step on a large thorn.”
No sooner had he shaped this thought than Gull cried out, “Squee! My foot!” “A
thorn, Cousin?” asked raven innocently. “Let me see-I will take it out for you.”
But of course it was so dark that he could not see the thorn to remove it.
“I must have light to take out the thorn,” said Raven.
Gull complained and hopped on one foot and wept, and he finally opened his cedar box a
crack, a crack so narrow that out glanced a shaft of light no brighter than a single star.
8
VU
Raven put his hand to Gull’s foot, then pretended not to see the thorn. Instead, he pushed
it in deeper.
“Squee, squee, squee!” screamed Gull, and in his pain he flung off the lid of the cedar
box.
Like a molten fish the sun slithered from the box, and light and warmth blazed out over
the world.
Nor was it ever to be recaptured, no matter how loudly or how sadly Gull called to it to return to
its safe hiding place beneath his wing.
Q1. Read the four statements given below. Select the one which best expresses the main idea of
the story.
‘C’ is the correct statement. “The release of daylight over the earth”.
3. What is a myth?
It is an ancient story containing magical and religious ideas. It describes an early attempt of
mankind to understand their surroundings and to give meaning to life.
An honest, plain sensible Country Mouse is said to have entertained in his hole, one day, a fine
Mouse of the Town. Having formerly been playfellows together, they were old acquaintances,
which served as an apology for the visit. However, as master of the house, he thought himself
obliged to do the honours of it, in all respects, and to make as great a stranger of his guest as he
possibly could. In order to do this, he set before him a reserve of delicate grey peas and meat, a
dish of fine oatmeal, some parings of new cheese, and to crown all, with a dessert, a remnant of a
charming mellow apple. In good manners her forbore to eat any himself, lest the stranger should
not have enough, but, that he might seem to bear the other company, sat and nibbled a piece of
wheaten straw very busily. At last, said the spark of the town, “Old Crony, give me leave to be a
little free with you: how can you bear to live in this nasty, dirty, melancholy hole here, with
nothing but woods, and meadows, and mountains, and rivulets about you?
Do you not prefer the conversation of the world to the chirping of birds; and the splendour of a
court to the rude aspect of an uncultivated desert? Come, take my word for it, you will find it a
change for the better. Never stand considering, but away this moment. Remember we are not
immortal, and therefore we have no time to lose. Make sure of to-day, and spend it as agreeably
as you can; you know not what may happen tomorrow.” In short, these and suchlike arguments
prevailed, and his country acquaintance was resolved to go to town that night. So they both set
out upon their journey together, proposing to sneak in after the close of the evening. They did so,
and about midnight made their entry into a certain great house, where there had been an
extraordinary entertainment the day before, and several titbits, which some of the servants has
purloined, were hid under the seat of a window. The country guest was immediately placed in the
midst of a rich Persian carpet: and now it was the courtier’s turn to entertain, who indeed
acquitted himself in that capacity with the utmost readiness and address, changing the courses as
elegantly, and tasting everything first as judiciously as any clerk of the kitchen.
The other sat and enjoyed himself like a delighted epicure, tickled to the last degree with this
new turn of his affairs; when, on sudden, a noise of somebody opening the door made them start
from their seats, and scuttle in confusion about the dining-room. Our country friend, in
particular, was ready to die with fear at the barking of a huge mastiff or two, which opened their
throats just about the same time, and made the whole house echo. At last recovering himself.
“Well,” said he, “if this be your town life, much good may it do you; give me my poor quiet hole
again, with my homely, but comfortable grey peas.”
10
VU
Reading exercises:
Just read the stories — Do not look up the meanings of words in the dictionary.
Q.2 Are there any specific lessons the authors want you to learn?
Consult your reading package for assignments related to the first lesson. Your next lesson will
deal with using the dictionary for learning pronunciation of English words.
Lesson -02
Pronunciation
This lesson is about the usage of a dictionary to know the pronunciation of English words.
The students of English are often worried about English pronunciation because spellings of
English words often cause confusion. The students generally face difficulty to pronounce a word
correctly after they read it.
This lesson is in two parts. In the first part, you will be familiarized with a set of special symbols
known as phonemic symbols that are used to indicate each speech sound.
The second part of the lesson consists of a few exercises.
Chorus k sound
Church chey sound
Ration sh sound
Machine sh sound
The word ‘chorus’ which begins with the letters ch is pronounced with the 'k' sound while in the
word church the letters ch is pronounced as the Urdu/Punjabi letter : .
e.g. In the word ‘ration’,- tion is pronounced as ‘sh’ while in the word ‘machine’- ‘ch’ is also
pronounced as ‘sh’
Remember that the phonemic symbols are given in slash brackets in the dictionary. / /
Now try to say these words louder. Pay special attention to the shape of your mouth and lips.
Notice that the symbols for long vowels have two small dots in front of them.
12
VU
Next we have 8 diphthong vowels. These are sounds which are produced by combining two
vowel sounds. There is a movement or glide from one vowel sound to another.
Now we will look at the consonant sounds / phonemes. In English there are 24 consonant
sounds. These are the sounds produced by the complete or partial stoppage of breath.
Stress
Stress is the extra force used in pronouncing or speaking a particular word. A dictionary will
indicate stress by a tiny mark on the top of a word like this: `
When you look up a word in the dictionary, be sure to learn where the stress falls on the word.
E.g.:
There are some words in English which have the same spelling but belong to different parts of
speech because they are stressed differently. E.g.
Computers are now an integral part of our lives. Many things, public or private, that we do
during the course of the day are affected by them. Visit any public organization or office, from
hospitals to schools, from the meteorological bureau to the stock exchange, etc. and you are sure
to come across people working at computers. Gone are the days when entries were made
manually in registers and ledgers at the bank. Now all monetary transactions are conducted by
the computer.
Most films and TV advertisements use graphics or pictures produced with the help of a
computer. There is hardly a sphere of life that does not involve the use of a computer.
Even when you go out on personal errands, to the travel agent to buy an airline ticket or book a
seat on the intercity bus, to the shopping plaza or a grocery store, the man behind the counter
uses a computer equipped with laser and bar code technology to scan the price of each item you
put before him and then uses it to add up the price to present you with a total, all within few
minutes.
A bar code is a pattern of thick and thin lines and spaces that represent characters that can be
read by a scanner. The bar code identifies the item to which it is affixed; the scanner transfers the
signal to a computer that matches the code to a price or inventory unit.
Computers are no longer things only encountered outside the home; they are very much a part of
the household items. One cannot imagine a world without computers.
Exercise I:
The passage will be read out a second time. As you read this passage you will see a list of
words on your TV screen.
Tick only the words that you hear being read.
14
VU
Exercise II:
You may face difficulty in using the right stress for the following words. Use dictionary to
find where the stress falls in the each word:
Lesson -03
Lesson 3 is devoted to develop your reading skills. It is the most important skill that you will
need for success in your studies. If you read inaccurately you will miss some of the information
or ideas that you read. If you read slowly, you will unnecessarily spend a lot of time in reading,
so your other work will suffer.
Your ability to read English rapidly and accurately depends upon purposeful practice. This lesson
will introduce you the ways by which you can improve your reading skills. You learn to read by
reading. You must continue to practice on your own later.
This lesson is in three parts. In the first part you will learn to identify the topic of a paragraph, in
the second part you will learn to pick the main idea of the paragraph and in the last part you will
learn to recognize details which support the main idea.
Topic of a paragraph
If you are able to identify the topic of a paragraph it will go a long way in developing your
reading ability. A good reader is quickly able to identify the topic of a paragraph.
What is the topic of a paragraph? It is the subject of the whole paragraph — i.e. what the
whole paragraph is about. It can usually be expressed in a word or two. When you read a
paragraph ask yourself the question: What is the writer trying to say or discuss throughout the
paragraph? And the answer that comes up (from your heart or mind) will surely be the answer.
Here are a number of short paragraphs taken from different text books. At the end of each
paragraph three or four possible answers are given. Select one which you consider is the topic of
the paragraph.
Text 1:
New species of plants are being discovered every year. It is estimated that the yearly average, for
the higher groups of plants alone is approximately 4700 proposed new species. It is obviously
necessary, from practical as well as scientific standpoint that attention be given to the naming
and the proper classification of the vast assemblage of plants, both native and cultivated. The
scientists who do these things are systematic botanists or taxonomists. Most certainly it is
essential for those working on the various fields of plant science- whether they are agriculturists,
florists, foresters, physiologists or morphologists- to know which plants they are dealing; they
must know their proper scientific names and their relationships. (Robbins et al.,
Botany, p. 7.)
16
VU
Text2:
The term Groups has long been a pivotal concept of sociology. A group is any number of human
beings in reciprocal communications. It may be well to emphasize certain aspects and
implications of this short definition which beginning students, as well as some sociologists
themselves, frequently overlook or do not appreciate fully. First, a group refers only to persons in
communication. Mere physical closeness, if there is not communication, does not make a group.
The communication creates the group, not the mere fact of spatial proximity or physical contact.
Second, a group maybe of any size from two persons, to theoretically and potentially the entire
population of the world. Third, communication need not be face-to-face or by “word of mouth”;
it may be indirect through writing or at long range through such instruments as the telegraph.
(Cuber, Sociology, p.273.)
A. communication in groups.
B. definition of a group.
C. social limitations of a group.
D. size of groups.
Text 3:
Plants absorb water and mineral salts from the soil; they take in oxygen and carbon dioxide from
the atmosphere. They manufacture sugars, starches, fats, proteins, and scores of other substances;
they conduct materials from one part of the plant to another; they respire, they grow; they react
to the environment in which they live; they reproduce. In short, plants carry on a number of
activities; they do work; they have functions. Plant physiology is the area of botany concerned
with the study of these activities and functions.
(Robinsetal., Botany, p. 9)
Topic: __________________________________________________
1. TOPIC SENTENCE
The Nile, the largest river in Egypt, is unique because it:
2. TOPIC SENTENCE
A little-known story about M.A. Jinnah tells about his manner of thinking.
3. TOPIC SENTENCE
If you want to spend your holidays in a truly unique place, the northern areas of Pakistan
are just the place for you.
Text 4:
TOPIC SENTENCE
Details:
A. By the time an infant is six months old, he or she can make twelve different speech
sounds.
B. Before the age of three months, most infants are unable to produce any recognizable
syllables.
C During the first year, the number of vowel sounds a child can produce is greater than the
number of consonant sounds he can make.
D. During the second year, the number of consonant sounds a child can produce increases.
E. Parents often reward the first recognizable word a child produces by smiling or speaking
to the child.
Text 5:
TOPIC SENTENCE
In some parts of the world, famine is a constant human condition and exists due to a variety of
causes.
Details:
A. In parts of Africa, people are dying of hunger by the tens of thousands.
18
VU
Text 6:
TOPIC SENTENCE
An individual deals with anxiety in a variety of ways and produces a wide range of responses.
Details:
A. Anxiety may manifest itself by such physical symptoms as increased heart activity
or labored breathing.
B. Fear, unlike anxiety, is a response to real or threatened danger.
C. Psychologically, anxiety often produces a feeling of powerlessness, or lack of
direct control over the immediate environment.
D. Temporary blindness, deafness, or the loss of the sensation of touch is examples of
extreme physical responses to anxiety.
E. Some people cannot cope with anxiety and are unable to control the neurotic
behavior associated with anxiety.
Before we end the lesson, let me go over what you have learnt in today’s lesson. In today’s
lesson you have learnt three important skills related with reading.
Lesson -04
In this lesson we will practice skills learnt in previous lessons. These skills are:
The given text is about computers. It consists of six paragraphs. Read the text once through
without stopping. As you read the text you will come across many words and expressions that
you are not familiar with. Do not be upset. Keep on reading. In your second reading, pause after
every paragraph and ask yourself - what the paragraph is about? You will find that each
paragraph has a topic, a main or a primary idea and / or secondary ideas that support the main
idea.
What is a computer?
1- A computer is a machine with an intricate network of electronic circuits that operate switches
or magnetize tiny metal cores. The switches, like the cores, are capable of being in one of two
possible states, that is, on or off: magnetized or demagnetized. The machine is capable of storing
and manipulating numbers, letters, and characters. The basic idea of a computer is that we can
make the machine do what we want by inputting signals that turn certain switches on and turn
others, off, or that magnetizes or de- magnetizes the cores.
2. The basic job of computers is the processing of information. For this reason, computers can be
defined as a device which accepts information in the form of instructions called a program and
characters called data, perform mathematical and / or logical operations on the information, and
then supply results of these operations. The program, or part of it, which tells the computers what
to do and also provides the information needed to solve the problem, is kept inside the computer
in a place called memory.
3. Computers are thought to have many remarkable powers. However, the most of computers,
whether large or small have three basic capabilities. First, computers have circuits of performing
arithmetic operations, such as: addition, subtraction, division, multiplication and exponentiation.
Second, computers have a means of communicating with the user. After all, if we couldn’t feed
information in and get results back, these machines wouldn’t be of much use. However, certain
computers (commonly minicomputers and microcomputers) are used to control directly things
such as robots, aircraft's navigation systems, medical instruments, etc.
4. Some of the most common methods of inputting information are to sue punched cards,
magnetic tape, disks and terminals. The computer’s input device (which might be a card
reader, a tape drive or disk drive, depending on the medium used in putting information) reads
the information into the computer. For outputting information, two common devices used are a
20
VU
printer which prints the new information on paper, or a CRT display screen which shows the
results on a TV-like screen.
5. Third, computers have circuits which can make decisions. The kinds of decisions which
computer circuits can make are not of the type: ‘Who would win a war between two countries?’
or ‘Who is the richest person in the world?’ Unfortunately, the computer can only decide three
things, namely: Is one number less than another? Are tow numbers equal? Is one number greater
than another?
6. A computer can solve a series of problems and make hundreds, even thousands, of logical
decisions without becoming tired or bored. It can find the solution of a problem in a fraction of
time. A computer can replace people in dull, routine tasks, but it has no originality; it works
according to the instructions given to it and cannot exercise any valuable judgments. There are
times when a computer seems to operate like a mechanical ‘brain’, but its achievements are
limited by the minds of human beings. A computer cannot do anything unless a person tells it
what to do and give it the appropriate information; but as electric pulses can move at the speed of
light, a computer can carry out vast numbers of arithmetic-logical operations almost
instantaneously. A person can do everything a computer can do, but in many cases that person
would be dead long before the job was finished.
(N. Mullen & P. Brown: English for Computer Science; OUP 16-18)
Paragraph 1:
A computer is a machine with an intricate network of electronic circuits that operate switches or
magnetize tiny metal cores. The switches, like the cores, are capable of being in one of two
possible states, that is, on or off: magnetized or demagnetized. The machine is capable of storing
and manipulating numbers, letters, and characters. The basic idea of a computer is that we can
make the machine do what we want by inputting signals that turn certain switches on and turn
others, off, or that magnetizes or de-magnetizes the cores.
Paragraph 2:
The basic job of computers is the processing of information. For this reason, computers can be
defined as a device which accepts information in the form of instructions called a program and
characters called data, perform mathematical and / or logical operations on the information, and
then supply results of these operations. The program, or part of it, which tells the computers what
to do and also provides the information needed to solve the problem, is kept inside the computer
in a place called memory.
Paragraph 3:
Computers are thought to have many remarkable powers. However, the most of computers,
whether large or small have three basic capabilities. First, Computers have circuits of performing
arithmetic operations, such as: addition, subtraction, division, multiplication and exponentiation.
Second, computers have a means of communicating with the user. After all, if we couldn’t feed
information in and get results back, these machines wouldn’t be of much use. However, certain
computers (commonly minicomputers and microcomputers) are used to control directly things
such as robots, aircraft's navigation systems, medical instruments, etc.
Topic: Powers of computers.
Main Idea: Three basic capabilities of computers
Supporting Idea: Computers are used to control robots, aircraft navigation systems, medical
instruments, etc.
Paragraph 4:
Some of the most common methods of inputting information are to sue punched cards, magnetic
tape, disks and terminals. The computer’s input device (which might be a card reader, a tape
drive or disk drive, depending on the medium used in putting information) reads the information
into the computer. For outputting information, two common devices used are a printer which
prints the new information on paper, or a CRT display screen which shows the results on a TV-
like screen.
Topic: Method of inputting information.
Main Idea: Input and Output devices.
Supporting Idea: Examples of devices.
14
Paragraph 5:
Computers have circuits which can make decisions. The kinds of decisions which computer
circuits can make are not of the type: ‘Who would win a war between two countries?’ or ‘Who is
the richest person in the world?’ Unfortunately, the computer can only decide three things,
namely: Is one number less than another? Are tow numbers equal? Is one number greater than
another?
Topic: Circuits that make decisions.
Main Idea: Computer can only make logical decision
Paragraph 6:
A computer can solve a series of problems and make hundreds, even thousands, of logical
decisions without becoming tired or bored. It can find the solution of a problem in a fraction of
time. A computer can replace people in dull, routine tasks, but it has no originality; it works
according to the instructions given to it and cannot exercise any valuable judgments. There are
times when a computer seems to operate like a mechanical ‘brain’, but its achievements are
limited by the minds of human beings. A computer cannot do anything unless a person tells it to
do something and give it the appropriate information; but as electric pulses can move at the
speed of light, a computer can carry out vast numbers of arithmetic-logical operations almost
instantaneously. A person can do everything a computer can do, but in many cases that person
would be dead long before the job was finished.
22
VU
Main idea
Now that you have read each paragraph in detail, let us look at the text as a whole.
Read the following four statements and choose the statement that best expresses the main
idea.
1. Computers have changed the way in which many kinds of jobs are done.
2. Instructions and data must be given to the computer to act on.
3. Computers are machines capable of processing and outputting.
4. Without computers, many tasks would take much longer to do.
Which statement did you choose? The correct answer is choice no.3
Why didn’t you select the other choices?
The other choices do not give the distinctive characteristics of what a computer is i.e. the main
idea of the passage. They simply provide the details.
Statements no. 1, 4 and 8 are false. These false statements can be made true by making necessary
changes.
1. Computer can store or handle any data which is input.
4. All computers can perform arithmetic operations, make comparisons and output information.
8. Computer can decide only these things:
-Is one number less than another?
- Are two numbers equal?
- Is one number greater than another?
Content Review
The following statements are all taken from the text you have just read. Certain words are
missing in these statements. Complete these statements with the appropriate words from the
word bank given below. Make sure that you use the correct form i.e. singular or plural. Some
words can be used more than once.
core device data circuit terminal switch programme
memory medium CRT display
1. Every computer has circuits for performing arithmetic operations, operating ___________ or
magnetized ______.
2. A ________ with a screen is normally referred to as a ______unit.
3. A computer is a ________ that processes information in the form of _______ and _______ and
can store this information in a ______.
4. Card readers, tape drives, or disk drives are different ______for inputting information.
24
VU
Lesson -05
In the last lesson you were introduced to two new terms: References and Connectives. The
sentences and paragraphs are not words, just put together; they express ideas which are
connected to each other. In this lesson, you will practice to recognize these words and phrases i.e.
references and connectives that link ideas in a sentence.
These words make the text smoother to read. Your reading speed and comprehension will
increase considerably if you are able to recognize the links between and within the sentences.
References are sometimes relative pronouns, sometimes demonstrative pronouns, or adverbs.
Sometimes they are substitutes for words that have come earlier or will come later.
We will first look at references within a text. Read the following seven sentences given below.
Notice the reference words are italicized and the connectives are underlined. The first five have
been done for you. Connect the last two on your own.
Text 1:
1. Mr. Salman bought a new car. His children haven’t seen it yet.
2. Our neighbor’s old car didn’t work, but their new one is fine.
3. Everyone seems to think the chairman is guilty. If so, he will probably resign. If not, we
should apologize to him.
4. Mrs. Mahmood thought the new curtains were a waste of money, and Saima, her daughter-in-
law thought the same.
5. Although the new Hostel warden doesn’t seem to trust the guard, everyone else did.
6. Shama liked the brown sofa but her husband, Salman. preferred the red.
7. The chair was so well made that Ms. Gull decided to buy two.
Connectives:
Now you will look at another kind of link which is made by conjunctions that join ideas into
some kind of relationship within the text. These words or phrases are also known as transitional
markers that connect ideas together. They indicate:
1. Result
2. Contrast
3. Comparison
4. Illustration / Example
5. Cause and Effect
6. A series / Time Sequence
7. Addition.
Examples:
1- Driving a motor car is a skill we learn through practice. Similarly, cooking is a skill we learn
through hands-on experience.
2- When family members communicate, they are more likely to solve their problems.
In a similar fashion, countries can best solve their problems through communication.
26
VU
Examples:
1. First I skim the newspaper to see what films are on, and then I circle the ones I want to record
on the VCR.
2. Previously, the two countries got along. Now, they have resumed diplomatic relations.
You will now look at two sample paragraphs. In the first paragraph the references are highlighted
and the connectives are underlined. The arrows connect the references to the ideas they relate to.
Sample 1
Some people, of course, still believe that Shakespeare could not have written the plays attributed
to him, but they have difficulty in explaining the fact that many contemporaries of Shakespeare,
who knew and worked with him, considered him, first, as the actual author, and second, a very
fine author indeed. Ben Johnson, for example, never doubted the authenticity of the plays.
William Green also referred to Shakespeare as a very fine playwright. These are only two of the
many contemporary references that leave little doubt that Shakespeare wrote the plays of
William Shakespeare.
(Yorkey: p. 133)
Sample 1 – A
References
Connectives
1- of course
2- but
3- first
4- second
5-for example
6- also
Sample 2
A computer like any other machine is used because it does certain jobs better and more
efficiently than humans. It can receive more information and process it faster than any human.
The speed at which a computer works can replace weeks or even months of pencil - and - paper
work. Therefore, computers are used when the time saved offsets their cost which is one of the
many reasons they are used so much in business, industry and research.
(N. Mullen & P. Brown: English for Computer Science p. 21 -22)
Sample 2 - A
1- it computer
2- It like any other machine, is used because
3- it information
4- their computers
5- which the time saved offsets their cost
6- they computers
Exercise 1
In the following paragraphs some words are highlighted. Draw a box around the word that the
bold words refer to. Then join the circle and the box with arrows. Also, underline any transitional
or connective word in the paragraph.
Paragraph 1:
Computers are electronic machines that process information. They are capable of
communicating with the user, of doing different kinds of arithmetic operations and of making
three kinds of decisions. However, they are incapable of thinking. They accept data and
instructions as input, and after processing it they output the results.
Paragraph 2:
When talking about computers, both hardware and software need to be considered. The
former refers to the actual machinery, whereas the later refers to the programs which control and
coordinate the activities of the hard ware while processing the data.
Paragraph 3:
The first computer was built in 1930 but since then computer technology has evolved a great deal.
There are three different kinds of computers in use today: the mainframe, the minicomputer and
the microcomputer. These all have one thing in common: they operate quickly and accurately in
solving problems.
(N. Mullen & P. Brown: English for Computer Science p. 21)
Exercise 1- A
1- that machines
2- they computers
3- they computers
4- it input
5- they computers
28
VU
6- former hardware
7- which programs
8- these the mainframes, the minicomputer, and the microcomputer
9- they do
Exercise 2
Fill in the gaps by using the correct connectives from the word bank.
Floppies are very cheap, _____________; they are slow and have a limited capacity. Hard
disks are fast and can store large amounts of data _____________ they are fixed inside the
computer, ___________ you cannot use them to transfer data. You can transfer data with
removable hard disks, _______________they are expensive. CD-ROM disks can hold quite
large amounts of data. ___________ they are usually read only ___________ you cannot
change the information on them. Magneto-optical disks are like CD-ROMs __________ you
can write data on to them. They are removable and have large capacities, ___________ they
are expensive and do not conform to a standard. ___________ they are not very common.
Magnetic tape is cheap and has a large capacity. __________ it does not allow random access
and drives are slow. ___________ it is only suitable for backups.
(Glendenning & McEwan Basic English for Computer Science Page 36)
Computers are the electronic machines that process information. They are capable of
communicating with the user, of doing different kinds of arithmetic operations and of making
three kinds of decisions. However, they are incapable of thinking. They accept data and
instructions as input, and after processing it they output the results.
When talking about computers, both hardware and software need to be considered. The former
refers to the actual machinery, whereas the latter refers to the programs which control and
coordinate the activities of the hardware while processing the data.
The first computer was built in 1930 but since then computer technology has evolved a great
deal. There are three different kinds of computers in use today: the mainframe, the minicomputer
and the microcomputer. These all have one thing in common: they operate quickly and accurately
in solving problems.
Recap:
Lesson -06
Reading Skills
This lesson will follow the pattern established by us in the earlier lessons. We will read a text to
help us in comprehension, and then we will do exercises based on that text.
When you read the following text, you will probably meet words and expression that are new to
you. First try to understand their meaning from the context - read the same passage a few times.
When you have read the whole text, check new words in a dictionary. Those words in bold
typeface are explained in the Glossary at the end of your reading package.
History of Computers
1. Let us take a look at the history of the computers. The very first calculating device used was
the ten fingers of a man’s hands. This, in fact, is why today we still count in the tens and
multiples of tens. Then the abacus was invented, a bead frame in which the beads are moved
from left to right. People went on using some form of abacus in the 16th century, and it is still
used in some parts of the world because it can be understood without knowing how to read.
2. During the 17th and 18th centuries, many people tried to find easy ways of calculating. J.
Napier, a Scotsman, devised a mechanical way of multiplying and dividing, which is how the
modern slide rule works. Henry Briggs used Napier’s ideas produced logarithm tables, which all
mathematicians use today. Calculus, another branch of mathematics, was independently invented
by Sir Isaac Newton, an Englishman, and Leibnitz, a German mathematician.
3. The first real calculating machine appeared in 1820 as the result of several people’s
experiments. This type of machine, which saves a great deal of time and reduces the possibility
of making mistakes, depends on a series of ten toothed gear wheels. In 1830 Charles Babbage, an
Englishman, designed a machine that was called ‘The Analytical Engine’. This machine, which
Babbage showed at the Paris Exhibition in 1855, was an attempt to cut out the human being
altogether, except for providing the machine with the necessary facts about the problem to be
solved. He never finished this work, but many of his ideas were the basis for building today’s
computers.
4. In 1930, the first analog computer was built by an American named Vannevar Bush. This
device was used in World War II to help the aim guns. MarkI, the name given to the first digital
computer, was completed in 1944. The men responsible for this invention were Professor
Howard Aiken and some people from IBM. This was the first machine that could figure out long
lists of mathematical problems, all at a very fast rate. In 1946 two engineers at the University of
Pennsylvania, J. Ecker and J. Mauchly, built the first digital computer using parts called vacuum
tubes. They named their new invention ENIAC. Another important advancement in computers
came in 1947, when John von Newmann developed the idea of keeping instructions inside the
computer’s memory.
5. The first general of computers, which used vacuum tubes, came out in 1950. Univac I is an
example of these computers which could perform thousands of calculations per second. In 1960,
30
VU
the second generation of computers was developed and these could work ten times faster than
their predecessors. The reason for this extra speed was the use of transistors instead of vacuum
tubes. Second generation computers were smaller, faster and more dependable than the first-
generation computers. The third generation computers appeared in the market in 1965. These
computers could do a million calculations in a second, which is 1000 times as many as first-
generation computers. Unlike second-generation computers, these are controlled by tiny
integrated circuits and are consequently smaller and more dependable.
Fourth-generation computers have now arrived, and the integrated circuits that are being
developed have been greatly reduced in size. This is due to microminiaturization, which means
that the circuits now fit onto a single chip. A chip is a square or rectangular piece of silicon,
usually from 1/10 to 1/4 inch, upon which several layers of an integrated circuit are etched or
imprinted, after which the circuit is encapsulated in plastic, ceramic or metal. Fourth generation
computers are 50 times faster than third-generation computers and can complete approximately
1,000,000 instructions per second.
6. The rate at which computer technology is growing; today’s computers might be obsolete by
1985 and most certainly by 1990. It has been said that if transport technology had developed as
rapidly as computer technology, a trip across the Atlantic Ocean today would take a few seconds.
EXERCISES:
1. Main Idea
Which statement best expresses the main idea of the text? Why did you eliminate the other
choices?
1. Computers, as we know them today, have gone through many changes.
2. Today’s computer probably won’t be around for long.
3. Computers have had a very short history.
Answer:
Main Idea: 1 and 3. Choice 2 is a prediction not a fact. It is not the main point in the description
of the history of computers.
1. The abacus and the fingers are two calculating devices still in use
today.
3. During the early 1880s, many people worked on inventing a mechanical calculating
machine.
6. Instructions used by computers has always been kept inside the computer’s memory.
7. Using transistors instead of vacuum tubes did nothing to increase the speed at which
calculations were done.
8. As computers were evolved, their size decreased and their dependability increased.
10. Computer technology has developed to a point from which new developments in the
field will take a long time to come.
Answers:
1. T
2. F - The slide rule is a modern invention
3. T
4. T
5. T
6. F- Instructions which are not being executed are usually kept in secondary
memory.
7. F- The use of transistors increased the speed at which calculations were done.
8. T
9. T
10. F- Computer technology is constantly developing and at a very fast rate.
3. Locating Information:
Find the passages in the text where the following ideas are expressed. Give the line
references.
……..1. During the same period of history, logarithm tables and calculus were
developed.
……..2. It wasn’t until the 19th century that a calculating machine was invented
which tried to reduce manpower.
……..3. Integrated circuitry has changed the computers further.
……..4. People used their fingers to count.
……..5. The computers of the future may be quite different from those in use
today.
……..6. Today’s computer circuits can be put on a chip.
……..7. Then an instrument with beads was invented for counting before a
mechanical way for multiplying and dividing was devised.
……..8. Transistors replaced vacuum tubes.
32
VU
Answers:
1. Paragraph 2
2. Paragraph 3
3. Paragraph 5
4. Paragraph 1
5. Paragraph 6
6. Paragraph 5
7. Paragraph 1
8. Paragraph 5
4. Understanding Words
Refer back to the text and find synonyms (i.e. words with a similar meaning) for the following
words.
1. machine (I. 2) ………………………
2. designed (I. 9) ………………………
3. a lot (I. 16) ………………………
4. errors (I. 17) ………………………
5. solve (I. 30) ………………………
Answers:
Refer back to the text and find synonyms (i.e. words with a similar meaning) for the following
words.
1. machine (paragraph1) device
2. designed ( paragraph 2) devised
3. a lot (paragraph 3) a great deal
4. errors ( paragraph 3) mistakes
5. solve ( paragraph 4) figure out
Now refer back to the text and find antonyms (i.e. words with an opposite meaning) for the
following words.
6. old (p 2) …………………
7. a few (p-3) …………………
8. to include (p-3) …………………..
9. contemporaries (p-5) …………………..
10. still in use (p-6) ………………….
Answers:
Now refer back to the text and find antonyms (i.e. words with an opposite meaning) for the
following words.
A B
1. Abacus a. instrument used for doing
2. calculus multiplication and division
3. analog computer b. used in the first digital
computers
4. digital computer c. an instrument used for
counting
5. vacuum tubes d. used in mathematics
6. transistors e. circuitry of fourth-
generation computers
7. chip f. Invented by Americans in
1944
8. microminiaturization g. made computers
smaller and faster
9. slide rule h. used to help aim guns
10. logarithm tables i. the reduction of circuitry
onto a chip
j. a branch of mathematics
Answers:
1. c
2. j
3. h
4. f
5. b
6. g
7. e
8. I
9. a
10. d
34
VU
New
Future Second-generation computers using
6. Focus Review:
New look back at the text ‘History of Computers’ and find out what the words in bold typeface
refer to.
1. that we know today
2. and it is still being used
3. which all mathematicians use today
4. which saves a great deal of time
5. that was called ‘The analytical Engine’
6. that could figure out long lists
7. They named their new invention
8. which could perform
9. And these could perform
10.that are being developed
Answers:
Now look back at the text ‘History of Computers’ and find out what the words in italics refer
to.
1. that we know today (history)
2. and it is still being used (abacus)
3. which all mathematicians use today (logarithm tables)
4. which saves a great deal of time (machine)
5. that was called ‘The analytical Engine’ (machine)
6. that could figure out long lists (machine)
7. they named their new invention (2 engineers)
8. which could perform (computers)
9. and these could perform (computers)
10.that are being developed (circuits)
Lesson -07
Word Formation
When you are reading, you will come across unfamiliar words. It is often possible to guess the
meanings of these words if you understand the way words are generally formed in English.
Learning the use and meaning of words in English can be made easier, and even enjoyable, if
you understand something about the way in which many English words are formed.
Prefix
Suffix
Stem
The stem of a word is its basic form, the fundamental element which is common to all the other
forms of the word. A prefix is a form which is fixed to the beginning of a stem; a suffix is a form
which is fixed to the end of a stem.
Example
Stem = measure
Suffix= measurable
Prefix =immeasurable
A prefix usually changes the meaning of a word while a suffix usually changes its part of speech.
E.g. the suffix -able changes verbs into adjectives (breakable, enjoyable). The prefix im- changes
the meaning to the opposite: measurable means capable of being measured; immeasurable means
“not capable of being measured.”
36
VU
By learning only a few prefixes and suffixes, you will be able to recognise or guess the meaning
of hundreds of English words.
The English language makes frequent use of this method of word formation. Notice the
numerous words formed on the stem act.
AFFIXES
Suffixes
Study these tables and try to find additional examples. Use your dictionary if necessary.
Noun-forming suffixes:
Verb-forming suffixes:
-ize computerize
ate automate, activate, calculate
-fy to make simplify
-en harden, widen
Adverb-forming suffixes:
Adjective-forming suffixes:
38
VU
It is sometimes difficult to locate base word, because their spellings frequently change when
suffixes are added to them.
1. If a base word ends in e, the e may be dropped when a suffix is added to it.
Mature +it y=maturity
2. If a base word ends in y, the y may be changed to i ,when a suffix is added to it:
harmony +ous=harmonious
3. Base words may undergo other spelling changes when suffixes are added to them:
reclaim+ation=reclamation (the I in reclaim is dropped)
Exercise1
Locate the base words in the boldface words and write them on the given lines.
Exercise 2
Read the following sentences and underline all the suffixes. Then try to find out what parts
of speech the words are.
1. The systems analyst provides the programmer with the details of the data processing
problems.
2. CRT terminals are very useful interactive devices for use in offices because of their speed
and quietness.
3. The new microcomputer we purchased does not have a Fortran compiler. It is
programmable in Basic only.
4. A computer is a machine with an intricate network of electronic circuits that operate
switches or magnetize tiny metal cores.
5. In very large and modern installations, the computer operator sits in front of a screen that
shows an up-to-date summary of the computer jobs as they are being processed.
6. The introduction of terminals and screens has partly replaced the use of punched cards.
7. Binary arithmetic is based on two digits: 0 and 1.
8. Multiplexing is when many electrical signals are combined and carried on only one optical
link.
9. Computers are machines designed to process electronically specially prepared pieces of
information.
10. The computed results were printed in tables.
Exercise 3
Fill in each blank with the appropriate form of the words.
40
VU
b. The students are still waiting for their acceptance into the Computer Sciences
program.
c. It is acceptable to work without a template if the flowcharts are not kept on the file.
a. The length of time a programmer takes to make a program will vary depending on the
complexity of the problem and his ability and experience.
b. One can always depend on a computer to obtain accurate answers because it’s probably the
most dependable machine in the world today.
Let us recap:
An English word can be divided into three parts: a prefix, a stem and a suffix. Prefix is what
comes before the stem. A suffix is what is attached to the end of the stem. A stem is the root of
the word. Both prefixes and suffixes are referred to as Affixes.n Esh word can be divided into
three parts:
42
VU
Lesson -08
We have already learned how words can be formed by looking at suffixes. In this lesson, we will
look at some other ways, beginning with prefixes and stem words, followed by synonyms and
antonyms as a means of enhancing your vocabulary.
A prefix is a letter or group of letters that is added to the beginning of a stem/ base word e.g. in
untrue the prefix is un- and the stem/base word is true. Words that are unfamiliar to you may
sometimes consist of a stem word you know and an added prefix, for instance:
We were shocked to learn of the illimitability of the dictator’s power.
Illimitability is a word that does not often appear in print. It may be unfamiliar to you. However,
you can locate its stem word, limit, which means ‘to restrict’. If you also know that the prefix il-
(as in illegal) means ‘not’, you should be able to determine that illimitability refers to which has
no limits or restriction. The sentence means ‘we were shocked to learn that there is no limit to the
dictator's power.
Now you will look at a list of words in which adapt is the stem/ base word. If this word is
preceded by a prefix you can make twenty -four additional words.
7
Prefix Meaning Example
1. un- not; no unhappy means not happy
2. non- not; no nonliving means not living
3. dis- not; no to distrust is not to trust
4. in- not; no indirect means not direct
5. Im- Not; no imperfect means not perfect
6. Ir- not; no irrational means not rational
7. Il- not; no illegal means not legal
8. a- not;
without atypical means not typical
9. pre- before prewar means before a war
10. post- after postwar means after a war
11. anti- oppos(ing) antiwar means opposing war
12. pro- favour(ing) prowar means favoring war
13. inter- between interstate means between states
Make sentences by writing the base/stem words and the meanings of the prefixes in the
boldface words on the lines provided.
Let us now consider some more prefixes, their usual meanings, and how they change the
meanings of English words. These prefixes will make words related to computers.
44
VU
PREFIXES
Study these tables and try to find additional examples. Use your dictionary if necessary.
Positive prefixes
Prefixes of Size
Prefixes of Location
Prefixes of Numbers
Other Prefixes
46
VU
Exercise 2
Read the following sentences and underline all the prefixes. Then try to find out what the
prefixes mean by referring back to the tables you have just completed.
Exercise 3
Fill in the blanks with the correct prefix from the following list. Use the glossary at the end
of the reading package.
multi deci- sub- inter semi- mono- mega- auto mini- de-
inter- prim –
Exercise 4
Read the following paragraph and underline the prefixes then complete the table that
follows it.
Computers may have a short history but prior to their development, there were many other ways
of doing calculations. These calculations were done using devices that are still used today; the
slide rule being a perfect example, not to mention the ten fingers of the hands. These machines,
unlike computers, were not electronic and were replaced by faster calculating devices. It wasn’t
until the mid-1940s that the first digital computer was built. The post-war industrial boom saw
the development of computers take shape.
By the 1960s, computers were faster than their predecessors and semiconductors had replaced
vacuum tubes by tiny integrated circuit boards. Due to microminiaturization in the 1970s, these
circuits were etched onto wafer thin rectangular pieces of silicon. This integrated circuitry is
known as a chip and is used in microcomputers of all kinds. It has been forecasted, by the end of
this decade, exceptionally faster and smaller computers will replace those in use today.
and complete the table
A computer can solve a series of problems and make hundreds, even thousands, of logical
decisions without becoming tired or bored. It can find the solution of a problem in a fraction of
time than it takes a human being to do the job. A computer can replace people in dull, routine
tasks, but it has no originality; it works according to the instructions given to it and cannot
exercise any valuable judgment. There are times when a computer seems to operate like a
mechanical ‘brain’, but its achievements are limited by the minds of human beings. A computer
cannot do anything unless a person tells it what to do and gives it the appropriate information;
but as electric pulses can move at the speed of light, a computer can carry out vast numbers of
arithmetic-logical operations almost instantaneously. A person can do everything a computer can
do, but in many cases that person would be dead long before the job was finished.beings. A
computer cannot do anything unless
Having dealt with the roots of words and how suffixes and prefixes work, let us look at another
way of enhancing your vocabulary:
Synonyms are words that have the same or nearly the same meaning. For example, big large,
huge, enormous monumental, gigantic, immense, and colossal are synonyms. Synonyms have
two characteristics that you must understand in order to use them appropriately.
First Characteristic:
Most synonyms have similar meanings in only one of their senses.e.g appropriate and apt are
synonyms when they are used to indicate that something is ‘fit’ for a specific purpose.
He made an appropriate remark
He made an apt remark
48
VU
Appropriate and apt may be used interchangeably to mean “fit” but they have other meanings
that they do not share. For instance apt may mean “likely”, but appropriate does not have this
meaning.
When he is nervous he is apt to laugh.
Here appropriate may not be used interchangeably with apt.
Second Characteristic:
Synonyms often have shades of meaning in addition to the meaning they share.
For instance blame and denounce are synonyms that refer to the act of making an unfavourable
judgement. However, to blame is to fix the responsibility for an error whereas to denounce is to
state intense disapproval in public. If you receive a letter in your letterbox that should have been
delivered to a neighbour, you may blame your postman, but you are not likely to publicly
denounce the postal employee for such a trivial mistake.
On the other hand, if elected officials are found guilty of stealing taxpayers’ money, they are
denounced; they are severely criticised in public, and in some cases thrown out of the office.
Blame does not convey the kind of unfavourable judgement that elected officials receive when
they betray the trust of those who elected them.
Final Mastery
Selecting Word Meanings
In each of the following groups, encircle the word or expression that is most nearly the same in
meaning as the word in boldface type in the introductory phrase.
1. Admonish the child
a. dress b. teach c. praise d. warn
2. Efface a wrong
a. discover b. wipe out c. hide d. apologize for
3. A perennial favorite
a. old-fashioned b. recent c. temporary d. enduring
Recap:
We have dealt with Vocabulary Building in this lesson by focussing on Affixes and Suffixes.
50
VU
Lesson -09
In this lesson we will read a text and then solve exercises based on that text. These exercises will
again emphasize and improve your reading comprehension abilities.
Characteristics
When you read the following text, remember to try and understand the meaning of new words
and expressions from the context. Don’t check new words in the dictionary until you have read
the whole text. Those words in bold typeface are explained in the Glossary at the end of the
book.om the context. Don’t check new words in the
[1] Computers are machines designed to process electronically the specially prepared pieces of
information which are termed as data. Handling or manipulating the information that has been
given to the computer, in such ways as doing calculations, adding information or making
comparisons is called processing. Computers are made up of millions of electronic devices
capable of sorting data or moving them, at enormous speed, through complex circuits with
different functions.
[2] All computers have several characteristics in common, regardless of design. Information, in
the form of instructions and data, is given to the machine, after which the machine acts on it and
result is then shown. The information presented to the machine is the input; the internal
manipulative operations, the processing; and the result, the output. These three basic concepts
of input, processing, and output occur in almost every aspect of human life whether at work or at
play.
For example, in clothing manufacturing, the input is the pieces of cut cloth, the processing is the
sewing together of these pieces, and the output is the finished garment.
STORAGE
[3] Figure 3.1 shows schematically the fundamental hardware components in a computer system.
The centerpiece is called either the computer, the processor, or, usually, the central processing
unit (CPU). The term ‘computer’ includes those parts of hardware in which calculations and
other data manipulations are performed, and the high-speed internal memory in which data and
calculations are stored during actual execution of programs. Attached to the CPU are the various
peripheral devices such as card readers and keyboards (two common examples of input
devices). When data or programs need to be saved for long period of time, they are stored on
various secondary memory devices or storage devices such as magnetic tapes or magnetic
disks.
[4] Computers have often been thought of as extremely large adding machines, but this is a very
narrow view of their function. Although a computer can only respond to a certain number of
instructions, it is not a single-purpose machine since these instructions can be combined in an
infinite number of sequences. Therefore, a computer has no known limit on the kinds of things it
can do; its versatility is limited only to the imagination of those who use it.
[5] In the late 1950s and early 1960s when electronic computers, in use today, were being
developed, they were very expensive to own and run. Moreover, their size and reliability were
such that a large number of support personnel were needed to keep the equipment operating. This
has all changed now that computing power has become portable, more compact, and cheaper.
[6] In only a very short period of time, computers have greatly changed the way in which many
kinds of work are performed. Computer can remove many of the routine and boring tasks from
our lives, thereby giving us more time for interesting, creative work. It goes without saying that
computers have created whole new areas of work that did not exist before their development.
Exercises
1: Main Idea
Which statement or statements best express the main idea of the text? Why did you eliminate
the other choices?
Decide whether the following statements are true or false (T/F) by referring to the information
given in the text. Then, make the necessary changes so that the false statements become true.
T F
1. All information to be processed must be prepared in such a way that the computer will
understand it.
52
VU
2. Because of the complex electronic circuitry of a computer, data can either be stored or
moved about at high speeds.
3. Not all computers can process data given to them and produce results.
6. All other devices used in a computer system are attached to the CPU.
9. Computers today cost less, are smaller, and need fewer people to operate them than in the
past.
3: Locating Information:
Find the passages in the text where the following ideas are expressed. Give the paragraph
reference.
………. 1. All computers are basically the same.
………. 2. Then arithmetic and / or decision-making operations are performed.
………. 3. Computers are limited by man’s imagination more than anything else.
………. 4. All the equipment used in a computer system is hardware.
………. 5. Computers are electronic machines used for processing data.
………. 6. If programs or data need to be kept for a long time, they are stored on tapes or
disks.
………. 7. First the computer accepts data.
……….8. Finally, new information is presented to the user.
4: Contextual Reference:
Look back at the text and find out what the words in bold typeface refer to.
5: Understanding Words:
Refer back to the text and find synonyms (i.e. words with a similar meaning) for the
following words.
1. called (para.1)………
2. tremendous (para.1)………
3. ideas (para.2)………
4. react (para.4)………
5. take away (para.6)………
Now refer back to the text and find antonyms (i.e. words with an opposite meaning) for the
following words.
6. taken away (para.2)………
7. wide (para.4)………
8. limited (para.4)………
9. immovable (para.5)……….
10. after (para.6)……….
6: Word Forms:
First choose the appropriate form of the words to complete the following sentences. Then
check the difference of meaning in your dictionary.
54
VU
processing, hardware, magnetic tape, input, processor, magnetic disk, output, secondary
memory, personnel, single-purpose
41
1. Information ………. takes place in the processor not in the input device or output device.
2. The ……. refers to all the electromechanical devices used in a computer installation.
3...…….. and ………. units are used as ……… storage devices.
4. A computer isn’t usually a ……. machine and may require quite specialized …….. to operate
it and all its related equipment.
42
7b: Content Review
Summarize the text on ‘characteristics’ by completing the following table.
SYSTEM COMPONENTS PARTS
Hardware 1.
2. Control Unit
3.
Peripheral devices 1.
A.
2. Disks
B. others 3.
4.
5.
6.
Organizing Information
A paragraph is a group of related sentences that develop an idea. In nearly every paragraph, there
is one idea that is more important than others. This idea is called the main idea of the paragraph
and is usually found at the beginning of the paragraph.
Sample Paragraph 1
All computers, whether large or small, have the same basic capabilities. They have circuits for
performing arithmetic operations. They all have a way of communicating with the person(s)
using them. They also have circuits for making decisions. 44
In this sample paragraph 1, the first sentence, ‘All computers, whether large or small, have the
same basic capabilities’ expresses the main idea of the paragraph.
All main idea sentences have a topic and say something about the topic.
Example
All computers, [topic] whether large or small, have the same basic capabilities.
[about the topic]
45
In some of your reading, finding main ideas may serve your needs but in much of your studying
you need to grasp details. It is sometimes more difficult to grasp and understand details than
main ideas. You will find it helpful if you think of details as growing out of the main idea. In
sample paragraph 1, there are three major details growing out of the main idea. These are the
major details:
46
A major detail often has minor details growing out of it. These minor details tell more about a
major detail, just as major details tell more about a main idea. In studying, you often find a
paragraph that has many small details that you must grasp and remember. Breaking up a
paragraph of this kind into its three components; the main idea, major details and minor details
will help you to understand and remember what it is about.
Sample Paragraph 2
It is the incredible speed of computers along with their memory capacity that make them so
useful and valuable. Computers can solve problems in a fraction of time. For this reason, they are
used in business to keep the record of accounts and airlines, train lines and bus lines use them to
keep track of ticket sales. As for memory, modern computers can store information with high
accuracy and reliability. A computer can put data into its ‘memory’ and retrieve it in a few
millionths of a second. It also has a storage capacity for as many as a million items.
If you were to organize this paragraph into its three components, it would look like this:
48
Main idea: It is the incredible speed of computers along with their memory capacity that make
them so useful and valuable
Major details: a. Computers can solve problems in a fraction of time
b. As for memory, modern computers can store information with high accuracy and reliability
Minor Details: a. Computers are used in business to keep their accounts.
b. Airlines train lines bus lines use them to keep track of ticket sales
c.A computer can put data into its memory and can retrieve it in a few millionths of a second.
d. it also has a storage capacity for as many as a million items.
49
56
VU
N.B. The major details in a paragraph are of equal importance. Because minor details grow out
of major details and also give information about major details, they are less important.
In making a block diagram you don’t have to write every word of the main idea sentence.
Exercise 1
Read the following paragraph and try to find the main idea, major details and minor details.
The computer has changed the production of copy in the newspaper industry. There are three
steps involved in the process: input, correction and output. First, the computer numbers each
story, counts words and gives a listing of the length of each story. Then a page is made up,
advertisements are placed in, the copy is shifted or deleted and corrections are made. Finally, the
computer hyphenates words and the result of all this is a newspaper page.
Main idea: The computer has changed the production of copy in the newspaper industry.
Major details:
Minor details:
52
Exercise 2
After reading the following paragraph, practice to find the main idea, major details and
minor details.
Railways use large computer systems to control ticket reservations and to give immediate
information on the status of its trains. The computer system is connected, by private telephone
lines, to terminals in major train stations and ticket reservations for customers are made through
these. The passenger’s name, type of accommodation and the train schedule is put into the
computer’s memory.
53
On a typical day, a railway’s computer system gets thousands of telephone calls about
reservations, space on other railways, and requests for arrivals and departures. A big advantage
of the railway computer ticket reservation system is its rapidity because a cancelled booking can
be sold anywhere in the system just a few seconds later. Railway computer systems are not used
for reservations alone. They are used for a variety of other jobs including train schedules,
planning, freight and cargo loading, meal planning, personnel availability, accounting and stock
control.
54
Main idea:
Minor details: Thousands of calls for reservations space, arrivals and departures.
58
VU
Lesson -10
Mainframes:
Large computer systems, or mainframes, as they are referred to in the field of computer science,
are those computer systems found in computer installations processing immense amounts of
data. These powerful computers make use of very high-speed main memories into which data
and programs to be dealt with are transferred for rapid access. These powerful machines have a
larger repertoire of more complex instructions which can be executed more quickly. Whereas
smaller computers may take several steps to perform a particular operation, a larger machine may
accomplish the same thing with one instruction.
These computers can be of two types: digital or analog. The digital computer or general-purpose
computer as it is often known makes up about 90 percent of the large computers now in use. It
gets its name because the data that are presented to it are made up of a code consisting of digits–
single-character numbers. The digital computer is like a gigantic cash register in that it can do
calculations in steps, one after another at tremendous speed and with great accuracy.
Digital computer programming is by far the most commonly used in electronic data processing
for business or statistical purposes. The analog computer works something like a car
speedometer, in that it continuously works out calculations. It is used essentially for problems
involving measurements. It can simulate, or imitate different measurements by electronic means.
Both of these computer types – the digital and the analog – are made up of electronic
components that may require a large room to accommodate them. At present, the digital
computer is capable of doing anything the analog once did. Moreover, it is easier to program and
cheaper to operate. A new type of scientific computer system called the hybrid computer has now
been produced that combines the two types into one.
Really powerful computers continue to be bulky and require special provision for their housing,
refrigeration systems, air filtration and power supplies. This is because much more space is taken
up by the input/output devices – the magnetic tape and disk units and other peripheral equipment
– than by the electronic components that do no make up the bulk of the machine in a powerful
installation. The power consumption of these machines is also quite high, not to mention the
price that runs into thousands of dollars.
The future will bring great developments in the mechanical devices associated with computer
systems. For a long time these have been the weak link from the point of view of both efficiency
and reliability.
Exercises :
1. Main idea
Which statement best expresses the main idea of the text? Why did you eliminate the other
choices?
1. Hybrid computers are a combination of digital and analog computers.
2. Digital computers are used more than any other type of computer.
Decided whether the following statements are true or false (T/F) by referring to the
information in the text. Then make the necessary changes so that the false statements
become true.
T F
2. Mainframes are very powerful and can execute jobs very rapidly and easily.
4. The analog computer is far smaller than a digital computer and therefore
occupies very little space.
5. The hybrid computer is a combination of both the digital and the analog
computer.
60
VU
10. Mainframe technology has reached the end of the road. No further
development is needed.
Answers:
Decided whether the following sentences are true or false (T/F) by referring to the
information in the text. Then make the necessary changes so that the false statements
become true.
3. Locating information :
Find the passages in the text where the following ideas are expressed. Give the line
references.
………. 1. Smaller computers may take longer to perform an operation.
………..2. More technological development is necessary in the mechanical devices
associated with computer systems.
………..3. Mainframes can operate quickly and execute more complex instruments.
….…….4. The hybrid computer is a combination of both digital and analog computers.
….……5. Digital computers are used more than analog computers.
….…….6. Mainframes are large powerful computers.
.……….8. Digital computers do calculations, one after another, quickly and exactly.
Answers:
Find the passages in the text where the following ideas expressed. Give the paragraph
references.
4. Contextual reference :
Look back at the text and find out what the words in bold typeface refer to.
1. which can be executed (line.7) …………….
2.
as it is often known (line.12)……………
3. that are presented to it (line.14)……………
4. in that it can do calculations (line.16)……………
5. in that it continuously works out (line.20)…………...
6. Both of these computer types (line.23)…………...
7. that may require a large room (line.24)…………...
8. that combines the two types (line.29)…………...
9. Require special provision for their housing (line.31)……………
10.that runs into thousands of dollars (line.37)…………….
Answers:
Look back at the text and find out what the words in bold typeface refer to.
62
VU
…………...
7. that may require a large room (p.2) electronic components
8. that combines the two types (p.2)Hybrid computer
9. Require special provision for
Theirhousing (p.3)computer
10.that runs into thousands of dollars (p.3)price
5. Understanding words
Refer back to the text and find synonyms for the following words.
Answers:
Refer back to the text and find synonyms for the following words.
Now refer back to the text and find antonyms for the following words.
6.ignored (l. 5) ……………………..
7.seldom (l. 12) ……………………
8.little (l. 16) ……………………
9.small (l. 30)…………………
10.weak (l. 35) ……………………
Answers:
Now refer back to the text and find antonyms for the following words.
6. Words forms:
First choose the appropriate form of the words to complete the sentences. Then check the
differences of meaning in your dictionary.
1. permission, permit, permissible, permitted
a. It is usually not ……… to smoke in a computer installation.
b. Computers ……….. people to use their time more effectively.
c. Building …………. is usually required before starting any renovations to a building for
computer department.
Answers:
First choose the appropriate form of the words to complete the sentences. Then check the
differences of meaning in your dictionary.
a. If microcomputer sales ……… to increase, it won’t be long before every household has one.
b. Computers can do repetitive operations……….. without getting bored.
c. There is a ……….interest in discovering new areas where computers can be used.
Answers:
continuation, continue, continuing, continuously
a. If microcomputer sales ……continue…… to increase, it won’t be long before every household
has one.
b. Computers can do repetitive operations……continuously…… without getting bored.
c. There is a …..continuing…… interest in discovering new areas where computers can be used.
Answers:
measurement, measure, measured, measurable
a. The analog computer is essentially used for problems is involving …measurement………
b. Because computer equipment is often bulky, the area used for a computer installation
must be……measured…… out carefully.
64
VU
c. The number of employees a computer company has can be seen as a ….measure …… of its
success in the business world.
Answers:
a. associated
b. associations
c. associates
Answers:
a. efficient
b. efficiently
c. efficiency
. There are many com…………….
a7. Content review:
Complete the following statements with the appropriate words. (Some can be used more than
once.) Make sure you use the correct form, i.e. singular or plural.
1. The …………. system is a computer which has combined the features of both the …….……
and ……….. computer. It is used mainly in scientific research.
2.……………computers get their name form the word……………These are single character
numbers that make up the …………. in which the data are presented to the computer for
processing.
3.……………… are usually found in large ………………
4. The most commonly used language of ………….. in the business community is ……………
Answers
1. hybrid computer, digital, analog
2. digital, digits, code
Lesson -11
Reading is the most important skill you will need for success in your studies. Poor reading may
be a problem for many of you, but it is not a hopeless one. We have been learning ways in which
you can improve your reading comprehension. Remember, this will only be an introduction. You
must continue to read and practice on your own. You learn to read by reading.
Our main concern is improving your comprehension. There is a relationship between reading
speed and reading comprehension. You may think that if you read rapidly, your comprehension
will suffer. This is a false assumption. As you push yourself to read slower you may find that you
comprehend less.
One cause of slow reading is VOCALIZATION - the forming of the sounds of each word even
though you may not say them aloud. Vocalization is very common among our students. It is a
sure sign that the reader is a poor reader. So, learn to read with your eyes and mind and not with
your lips. In simple words learn to read silently.
If you learn to recognize and understand the principles and methods of writing - rhetoric - it will
help improve your reading. If you learn to understand why a piece of text or writing was written,
what it says, both in overall statement and major sub points, and how the author or writer has
made those major statements and the minor sub parts fit in, it will help improve your
understanding of the reading text.
All successful writers work along these lines. The way they write will provide answers to the
three questions - Why? What? And How?
An important part of reading is realizing that everything you read has an author or writer who
has something to say, and he says it in a particular way or manner. You, as a successful reader,
must apply the same technique that the writer used - the questions, why? What? How? And
decode what he has said.
To answer the first question - Why? - remember the author is a person who has a reason for
writing a given piece of text, and who works from a personal point of view. As a skilled reader
you must fully understand and evaluate what you read. The writer has a purpose in writing. You
must recognize that PURPOSE. Aligned with purpose are two other things which are known as
ATTITUDE and TONE - the expression of the writer’s feelings.
There are 3 common purposes of communication: to inform, to persuade and to entertain. When
the purpose is to inform, the writer gives information on facts about the topic or subject he is
writing about. When the purpose is to persuade, the aim is to convince the
reader to agree with the writer’s point of view. Here, also writers may give facts but their
main goal is to promote an opinion. For the third purpose which is to entertain, the author
appeals to the reader’s senses and imagination with the aim of amusing and delight.
66
VU
Closely related to the question of purpose is the matter of ATTITUDE. What is the writer’s
attitude toward his purpose, and toward his subject, or toward you, the reader? Even if he is
arguing, he can be arguing coolly and logically, or angrily and heatedly. He can see something
funny in the situation or something frightening.
Similarly, he can approach his audience - the readers as friends, as enemies, as equals, or he can
talk down to them from a position of authority. Attitude, then, is the author’s approach, position,
the stance that he adopts towards the material he is presenting, the audience i.e. you, the reader
and the situation in which he is writing.
A good clue to the author’s attitude and approach to the subject is his TONE. This is the voice in
which he is speaking to you - the language, the words and phrases he chooses to write. It is
through the author’s tone that we sense his wit, humor, sadness, indignation, friendliness etc.
Just as a speaker’s voice can project a range of feelings, a writer’s words and phrases can project
one or more tones or feelings. Understanding tone is an important part of understanding what the
writer has written. Sometimes, tone is evident from the first line, from the first paragraph.
Sometimes, the tone, purpose and attitude will not be evident or clear to you until the entire piece
or text has been read.
Authors and their works are complex. An author may use different types of writing to put
forward his views. He may narrate, describe, explain or argue. Not all writing fits neatly into one
of these categories. He may combine all these types in one piece of writing. Description and
narration are often used to help developing a further purpose – either Exposition or Argument.
Or he may use exposition to develop an argument. Thus, you may find combinations of purpose
involved in what you read. The same approach can apply to humor and entertainment. If you can
find out what is the underlying purpose and intention of the author, and what technique or
strategy he is employing, then you are a successful reader.
All this might not be evident in your first reading. So, this means you will have to re-read. At
least, this might be necessary till you are a practiced reader. You cannot always rely on your first
reading to bring you the comprehension, the analytical understanding. But the clues that your
first reading will supply will then be valuable in your re-reading.
The second technique that the writer uses - the WHAT question. What the writer says in the
overall statement and major sub points of the text leads us to the author’s basic
statement - his thesis statement about his subject. For you, the reader, the thesis also indicates
what the writer is NOT saying. It shows you the limitations the writer has set for himself, how
much of the general subject he is going to deal with. A good reader makes sure that he reads
within the boundaries of those limitations.
To help readers understand their main points, authors try to present supporting details in a clearly
organized way. Details might be arranged in any of several common patterns. Sometimes,
authors may build a paragraph or longer passage exclusively on one pattern; very often the
patterns are mixed. By recognizing the patterns, you, the reader, will be better able to understand
and remember what you read.
The most commonly used patterns of organization or subdivisions are time order /
sequences. List of items, comparison or contrast, cause and effect, definition and example. These
subdivisions complete the pattern of the writer’s basic statement, his thesis, his main thought.
The reader’s recognition and understanding of these subdivisions are a part of answering the
question HOW - the third important technique used by the writer. Recognition of the main
subdivisions is recognition of the techniques and devices of the organization.
Paragraphs and particularly, the topic sentences of paragraphs are important clues. The topics of
the individual paragraphs are the core statements in explaining the thesis: each paragraph will
make some kind of core statement and then develop it with some concrete details.
In short pieces of writing each paragraph may be a separate subdivision; in longer pieces, a
number of paragraphs may form a subdivision, each contributing to the total understanding.
Relationships between the parts are conveyed throughout a text by transitions. Recognition of
these transitions - the movement from or connection between one part and the next will lead to a
general improvement of your reading. In other words it means noticing important words and
phrases which connect the parts. These may be function words or content words.
Function words are an important part of writing and reading and are used no matter what the
subject of the text is. These are the small words such as in, at, and, but… the prepositions, the
conjunctions, the modifiers, etc. They establish emphasis and relationships between the parts.
They are the chief clues to the organization of a piece of writing.
Content words are those words that are central to the development of the subject of any particular
piece of writing. They are often words that are most fully defined. But it is also possible that the
author assumes you know their definitions. In either case you, the reader, have to be sure you
understand these key words. Also you need to notice how an author modifies key content words
at different parts of the text. He may use synonyms
i.e. use other words with similar meaning or he may use antonyms – words that are in contrast to
the key content words.
The successful reader learns to recognize and understand the clues that the writer gives. This can
only happen through practiced reading.
68
VU
An Approach to Comprehension
You have probably realized by now that everything you learn in this course is geared towards the
end of writing and understanding English and nothing is merely an exercise learnt for
examination purposes. What we call ‘comprehension exercises’ are in fact a test of this
understanding. Up till now, you have been dealing with computer related passages, now we will
shift gear and make you look at other kinds of reading materials.
The pieces of writing we use will be of two varieties: imaginative and practical.
The ‘imaginative’ passage will be a piece of creative writing, an extract from a novel or a short
story dealing with a fictional situation; it could alternatively be a poem.
(a) In answering the questions you will show that you can understand what the writer is talking
about, not just on the surface, but also the subtleties and implications.
(b) You will also need to say something about how the writer is getting his points over, the
effectiveness or otherwise of the way he uses words, images and sentences to create particular
effects. In other words, some insight into matters of style and the appropriateness of style to
content will be demanded. The ‘practical’ passage will deal mainly with facts. It may be a report,
an account or someone expressing his opinions on a particular matter, a series of instructions or a
set of statistics which you will be asked to interpret. The emphasis here will be on making sure
that you can understand the line of argument or the logical step-by-step statement of the facts.
You may be asked to summarize the points made in the passage about a particular aspect of the
matter being discussed. Keep in mind that the computer texts that we did in the earlier lessons
were factual texts.
Kinds of Questions: The kinds of questions on reading passages are likely to be as follows:
1. Meaning. You may be asked to explain the meaning of the word or phrase as it is used in the
passage, e.g. when you see the word ‘execute’, you may immediately think of the meaning
‘inflict capital punishment on’. But this would not be an appropriate meaning in a context like
this: ‘To execute the plan for redevelopment of the town we will call for the support of all
citizens.’ Here ‘execute’ means ‘carry into effect’.
2. Facts. You may be asked to answer questions about what the passage is actually saying to
make sure that you understand it, e.g. if the piece of writing is about a character digging his
allotment, you may be asked ‘what is the character doing?’
3. Reading between the lines. Writers do not always state facts directly. They imply emotions
and attitudes and suggest points of view, and they depend on the reader being perspective enough
to be able to form a total impression greater than the bare words on the page. For instance, an
author may not state directly that he dislikes a particular character he is writing about, but the
words he uses to describe that character and the situations he presents him in may convey the
author’s attitude towards the character, and that attitude is passed on to the perceptive reader. The
words are not chosen accidentally but with a purpose, and you must be able to get beyond the
surface meaning of the words and see what the implications of such words are. For example:
(a) The same soldiers could be called ‘terrorists’ or ‘freedom-fighters’, according to the writer’s
attitude towards them.
(b) In describing someone eating, a writer may use the words ‘wolfed down’, ‘slobbered’,
‘guzzled’. If he is describing a baby eating, these words may be merely a statement of fact, but if
they are about an adult, there may well be a suggestion of distaste towards the character.
4. Metaphorical language. You may be asked to explain what it is exactly that a writer has in
mind when he makes a comparison or uses a metaphorical expression, e.g. in The Story by Dylan
Thomas, the author says ‘my uncle blew and bugled whenever he won’ (at cards). The word
‘blew’ suggests a literal and factual way of expelling; the breath from his mouth in a burst, but
the word ‘bugled’ is being used in a metaphorical way. Thomas is making a comparison between
the noise his uncle made and the sound of a bugle. He is trying to make more vivid, to our
imaginations, the kind of noise his uncle made. The word ‘bugled’ suggests things like ‘high-
pitched’, ‘strident’, ‘sudden and loud’, perhaps even ‘triumphant’. These are ideas which this
metaphorical use of the word conveys which otherwise, a literal word could not produce.
5. Style. Just as people are individual and different, so the way they write varies. In addition, a
particular writer may write in different ways depending on what effects he is trying to achieve,
e.g. he may use very flowery language if he is trying to create an atmosphere; he may write very
simple if he is concerned with getting important facts over; he may have his tongue in his cheek.
You may be asked to comment on the style of the passage you are studying and you may have to
justify the appropriateness and effectiveness or otherwise of the style to the content – what the
writer is saying. The kinds of points you would have to be aware of are the variety of sentences
used, the kinds of words chosen, particular literary devices he uses, etc. These are very important
aspects of understanding writing, and they will be discussed in greater detail in later units.
6. Summary. You may be asked to pick out certain facts in a passage relevant to a particular
point, e.g. you may be asked ‘what do we learn about X’s physical appearance?’ and you will
have to search through the piece of writing to find all the details that the writer gives you about
this.
7. Opinions. You may be asked to comment on the views expressed in the passage, to say
whether you think they are convincing, or to give your own views on the topic, e.g. if the passage
is about homeopathy, you may be asked, ‘Do you think Homeopathy is harmful?’ Or you may be
asked to develop or expand on an area of experience described in the passage, but this time
treating it from a personal point of view. For example, the passage may be about working
conditions, and you may be asked, ‘Comment on the conditions under which you work,
indicating the area in which you think improvements could be made.’
70
VU
These are the main kinds of questions and approaches you are likely to be asked. There may be
others, but if you become acquainted with these types of questions and texts and can understand
them, you should be well prepared confident.
Listing
It is important when reading to recognize and understand the relationship in which sentences and
groups of sentences combine to present information. This information may be linked by means
of a connective word or marker. Making a list, enumerating, and giving instructions, indicates a
cataloguing of what is being said. It is important to note that most enumerations belong to clearly
defined sets. The following table is a list of the markers that can be used to show the order in
which things are to be said.
LISTING MARKERS
1, 2, 3, etc.
One, two, three, etc.
First(ly), second(ly), third(ly)
In the first/second/third place
Another, next, then
Furthermore, afterwards, moreover
Lastly/finally
to begin/start with, and to conclude
First and foremost mark the beginning
First and most important(ly) of a descending order
Above all mark the end of
Last but not least an ascending order 42
There are many ways of showing sequential relationships. Those given in the table above are not
the only ones, they are the most common ones used in listing or enumerating. The –ly forms are
usually used when listing.
Sample Paragraph
More and more police departments have now sophisticated devices to help control the increasing
crime rate. Some of these are: Firstly, a computer terminal inside a police vehicle to answer an
officer’s questions; secondly, a computer-controlled display unit for
displaying fingerprints; and thirdly, educational systems for police officers such as terminals,
enabling them to verify changes in laws, rules and regulations. The computer memory of many
law enforcement systems contains all kinds of information. First and foremost, it has data on
stolen items such as cars, license plates and property. Second, it has information on missing
persons and wanted fugitives. Last but not least, it contains information on political extremist
groups and their activities. It goes without saying that computers have certainly revolutionized
police work by providing access to millions of items of information with the least possible delay
and speeding up the process of apprehending suspicious-looking characters.
Exercise 1
The following paragraph is an excerpt from a passage you have read earlier. ‘What Is a
Computer? While reading this paragraph underline the listing marks. Computers are thought to
have many remarkable powers. However, most computers whether large or small have three
basic capabilities. First, computers have circuits for performing arithmetic operations, such as
addition, subtraction, division, multiplication and exponentiation. Second, computers have a
means of communicating with the user. After all, if we couldn’t be of much use. Third,
computers have circuits which can make decisions. The computer can only decide three things:
1. Is one number less than another?
2. Are two numbers equal? And
3. Is one number greater than another?
Exercise 2
Complete the following paragraph by filling in the blanks with appropriate listing markers.
Computers can do wonders, but they can waste a lot of money unless careful consideration goes
into buying them. Any businessman thinking of buying a computer system should ..… admit he
knows very little about computers….., he must realize that the computer salesman doesn’t know
how his business works.
.…., that he should get that outside advice is a must, not necessarily from consultants but from
other executives who have had recent experience buying a computer system ..… He should try to
see systems similar to ones under consideration in operation. Because his operations will have
the differences that must be accommodated, he should ….. find out what would be involved in
upgrading a system. ….. Important thing to know before buying a computer is the financial
situation of the supplier because computer companies come and go and not all are financially
stable. ….. the perspective buyer should demand that every details be covered in writing.
Including hardware and software, they are supplied by different companies. There’s nothing
wrong with computers, it’s how and why they are used that can cause problem.
72
VU
Lesson -12
Our aim is to help you not only become a better reader but a strong thinker – a person able not
only to understand what is read but to analyze and evaluate it as well. In fact, reading and
thinking are closely related skills, and practice in thoughtful reading will also strengthen your
ability to think clearly and logically. It is a higher level skill.
In everyday life, we keep on making inferences. For example, you go out in the street and you
notice a large crowd gathered outside a shop, and you also notice a lot of broken glass on the
road. As you get closer, you hear loud talking. Before you even reach the shop, you have inferred
what all the fuss is about - there has been an accident.
How did you arrive at these inferences? First, you used your experience of life and general
knowledge of people. Second, you made informed guesses which were based on the facts you
observed. Remember not all your inferences will necessarily prove true. For example, it is
possible that the crowd gathered outside is not because of an accident between cars etc. but
because of a quarrel among some people and while fighting among themselves they hit the glass
windows of the shop and it turned into a nasty brawl. In any case, the more evidence you have,
the more solid your inferences are.
1. Consider two incidents. Write down on a piece of paper what you might infer if you saw
the following two occurrences.
i) A high school has policemen walking up and down its main hall.
What would you infer? _______________
ii) A dog shrinks or cringes when you try to pat him.
What would you infer? _______________
The inferences you probably made are that, in the first situation, there is a public examination
going on/or there is an important function taking place and some high-ranking person is present.
And in the second situation you probably inferred that the dog has previously been maltreated
and is afraid of people.
Look at the following two pictures on your screen and put a tick mark against the inference(s)
most logically supported by the information given in the picture.
Picture 1:
Picture 2 :
74
VU
Inferences in Reading:
In reading also we make logical jumps from the information given or stated directly to ideas that
are not stated directly i.e. we make statements or draw conclusions about what is not known on
the basis of what is known or given. So, to draw inferences the reader uses all the clues provided
by the writer, his own experience i.e. the reader’s own experience and logic.
2. Read the sentences given below and mark the inference most logically based on the
information in the sentence.
Sohail always sits in the last row of the classroom.
a. Sohail dislikes his college courses.
b. Sohail is unprepared for his class.
c. Sohail feels uncomfortable sitting in the front row.
d. Sohail is farsighted
The given sentence tells us nothing about how Sohail feels about his college courses, how
prepared he is, or how well he sees. So answers a, b or d are possibilities, but none is directly
suggested by the sentence. The correct answer is therefore c. Based on the information we are
given, we can conclude only that Sohail – for some reason – does not like sitting in the front. We
are not given enough information to know why he feels this way. Remember your inferences will
be stronger if you don’t jump to conclusions that are unsupported or that are only very weakly
supported by the available information.
3. Now you will have some more practice in drawing inferences. Read the given sentences and
put a tick mark by the inference, most logically supported by the information given in the
sentence.
1. The Arabic language contains numerous words describing different types of camels.
a. There is really only one kind of camel.
b. The Arabic language clearly has many times more words than the English language.
c. The Arabic language probably also has numerous words for different types of dates.
d. The exact nature of camels is important to the desert way of life.
2. A man enters his office building, marches past a group of fellow employees without returning
their greetings and goes into his office, slamming the door.
4. Read the passage & then check the four statements which are most logically supported by the
information given.
Retail stores, banks, and brokerage houses use on-line transaction processing to obtain instant
information and to conduct transactions. Laser scanning and bar codes are transforming the
physical handling of codes by retailers and wholesale distributors. A final example of
technological change affecting jobs is the widespread use of televisions, telephones, and personal
computers for the purposes of home banking and shopping.
76
VU
c) Your mother and I were so happy then. It seemed as though we had everything we could ever
want. I think the last day the sun shone was when that dirty little train steamed out of that
crowded, suffocating Indian station, and the battalion band playing for all it was worth. I knew in
my heart it was all over then. Everything!
(No statements are given for these paragraphs)
((99922
Inferences in Literature:
If you are fond of reading novels, short stories, poetry, etc. you might be aware that inference is
very important in understanding and appreciating literature. While nonfiction writers, that is,
writers of factual material, usually state directly what they mean, fiction or creative writers often
show what they mean by describing the scene or situation. It is for the reader to infer the point of
what the writer has to say. I shall illustrate this with an example. A non-fiction writer might
write:
Henry was angry at his wife.
A fiction/creative writer might write:
Henry’s eyes narrowed when his wife spoke to him. He cut her off in the middle of the sentence
with the words,” I don’t have time to argue with you.”
23
Instead of simply stating that Henry was angry, the creative writer has through his description
shown Henry’s anger. If you read literature – poetry, short stories, novels, biographies, etc… you
need to apply inference skills. Your understanding and appreciation of such works where a lot of
meaning is implied i.e. not stated directly, will depend on this skill. Now, I shall read a very short
poem of four lines. It is written by the American poet James Russell Lowell and is called “Sixty
– Eight Birthday”.
24
As life runs on, the road grows strange
With faces new, and near the end
The milestones into headstones change,
‘Neath every one a friend.
J. R. Lowell
Milestone: a slab of stone set up in the ground to show the distance in miles on a road.
Headstone: a stone which marks the top end of a grave, usually having the buried person’s name
on it.
25
1. We infer that the speaker in the poem is sixty-eight although the poem does not state that the
speaker is sixty eight. The title of the poem strongly implies it. That is the purpose of the title.
2. The poem compares life to a road with milestones – 1st & 3rd lines suggest that life runs on a
road marked by milestones along it. As we move along the road, we meet new faces of people we
are not familiar with.
3. The poem implies that birthdays are like milestones that mark the distance covered i.e. the
years lived.
A time comes when life’s milestones turn into headstones, the markers set into graves, meaning
in other words that life ends in death.
4. The final line implies that as we get older, more and more friends die. Under all the headstones
are friends. Now we will discuss another short poem. Read the poem titled ‘Fog’ by Carl
Sandburg and answer the questions given at the end.
27
Fog
The fog comes
On little cat feet.
It sets looking ones harbor and city
On silent haunches
And then moves on.
C Sandburg
Put a tick mark against the answer that is based on the poem.
1. The way the fog moves is compared to:
a. The movements in the harbor
b. The movements in the city
c. The way a cat moves
28
2. This comparison implies that the fog:
a. floats over the harbor.
b. hangs over the city.
c. moves quickly and silently.
Another way in which writers can indicate character is through the words they put into their
character’s mouths. The readers have to read between the lines and infer meanings which may
not be directly stated. This is true of novels and other genres of literature. In drama, for example,
playwrights expect their audience to read between the lines of the dialogue and use inference to
depict the diversity of their characterization.
31
This is, of course, an important- possibly the most important element of the dramatist’s art, to
reveal his characters through their speech, but other writers employ the device as well.
Study the following passage from P.G.
78
VU
Look at Jeeves’s answers. Apart from one’s speech, they are very economical. What can
we deduce about the kind of person Jeeves is, and his attitude towards his master from this
economy of speech? What Jeeves actually says and what is implied?
35
In today's lesson you’ve had practice in reading between lines. First in non-fiction or factual
writing and then in creative writing for finding out meaning that is not stated directly. This is a
skill that you can only acquire by reading extensively.
Lesson -13
In this lesson we will be looking at different ways of determining fact from opinion. In the
second half, we will be looking at different ways of indicating time sequences in practical
scientific texts.
What is a fact? A fact is a statement that can be proved true through objective evidence. Now,
this evidence may be a physical proof, or the testimony of witnesses (spoken or written). The
following are some facts which can be checked for accuracy and thus can be proved true:
1. The neem tree in our garden is 25 feel tall. (Anyone can measure & confirm or disprove the
fact.)
2. The Lahore Museum is the oldest museum in Pakistan. (Any researcher can check with
historical publications/documents.)
3. Pakistan won the 1992 World Cup. (Anyone can check sports record to confirm this)
“Beautiful” is a value-word – the word we use to express our judgment. Now remember value-
words are signals that an opinion is being expressed. These value-words by their very nature
represent opinions, not facts. e.g.
1. The Prime Minister should have willed his property to the nation (That’s your opinion).
2. Pakistan cricket team is the best in the world. This, again, is an opinion. ‘Best’ is debatable.
80
VU
To sharpen your understanding about fact and opinion, read the following statements and
decide whether they are facts (F) or opinions (O).
1. My brother, Aslam, is very handsome.
2. Last night there was an accident on the highway.
3. Mohammad Ali Bogra was the worst Prime Minister our country had ever had.
4. Ostriches do not hide their heads in the sand. (Contrary to popular opinion, this is a fact which
can be checked through observation or reports of observations.)
If someone says, “It’s raining outside”. Now, this observation is an objective one. It can be
verified, but if someone says, “It’s bad weather”, this is a subjective statement - a personal
interpretation of reality – some people consider rain to be good weather!
(iv) Much of what we read and hear is a mixture of fact and opinion:
Recognizing facts and opinions is important because a lot of information that we read and hear is
really OPINION.
So far, you have read single statements; now you will read a passage. Be on the look out for
opinion.
1- There were several queens of Egypt by the name of Cleopatra, which also includes the one
who ruled in the time of Caesar and Antony, the rulers of Rome.
2- She is one of the most interesting figures in the world and Egyptian history.
3- According to historical records, she was born in 69BC and died almost forty years later.
4- The story of how she died is very fascinating and easy to believe.
5- Reports say that she killed herself by letting a cobra bite her.
6- As the Egyptian cobra was a symbol of royalty, so it was a good way for a queen to end her
life.
.
18
Sentence 2. expresses an opinion – to some Cleopatra may not be an interesting figure.
Sentence 4 - opinion: how fascinating and easy to believe will differ from person to person.
Sentence 6 - mixture of fact and opinion.
1- Although weeds are also plants, there is something negative about the name.
2- R. W. Emerson, an American poet once described a weed as “a plant whose virtues have not
yet been discovered”.
3- Weeds aren’t really so bad after all.
4- For instance, they can replenish depleted top soil with minerals.
5- Also, some weeds contain vitamins and are edible.
Read the following statements and decide whether they are facts or opinions:
1. Edgar Allan Poe is the greatest writer of horror stories in the world. _______________
2. Poe had to leave the University of Virginia because he couldn’t pay his debts.__________
3. Edgar Allan Poe should not have drunk so much.___________________
4. Lovecraft has often been compared to Edgar Allan Poe.___________________
5. When Lovecraft died, he was practically unknown.___________________
6. Lovecraft died in the conditions of shameful neglect.________________
7. Lovecraft’s stories are far more horrible than those of Edgar Allan Poe.______________
8. Edgar Allan Poe’s stories reflect his powerful imagination and his love for
analysis._______________
9. Baudelaire wrote that Edgar Poe ‘pursued imagination and subjected it to the most stringent
analysis’.____________________
10. It is because of Baudelaire that Edgar Allan Poe became famous in
France._________________
1 a) You might like to ask why the Sun is able to supply its own light, heat, and energy, whereas
the Earth and the other planets only shine feebly with the aid of borrowed light. Strange as it may
seem, it is best to start this problem by considering the interior of the Earth.
82
VU
b) The morrow brought a very sober-looking morning, the sun making only a few efforts to
appear; and Catherine augured from it everything most favourable to her wishes. A bright
morning so early in the year, she allowed, would generally turn to rain; but a cloudy one foretold
improvement as the day advanced.
c) Your mother and I were so happy then. It seemed as though we had everything we could ever
want. I think the last day the sun shone was when that dirty little train steamed out of that
crowded, suffocating Indian station, and the battalion band playing for all it was worth. I knew in
my heart it was all over then. Everything!
The Sequences
In lesson 11, we looked at some of the markers used for enumerating the order in which things
are to be said when making lists or giving instructions. However, it didn’t mention those markers
which outline the time sequence in which events occur. It is equally important to recognize the
sequence of events, especially in such activities as scheduling, recounting historical facts, doing
routine activities and conducting and describing experiments.
As we know, events do not simply occur; they occur either before, during or after other events.
This time sequence may be chronological, logical or causal. Once a time-reference has been
established, certain adjective and adverbials may order subsequent information in relation to it.
The following tables are examples of time relaters.
Table1:
Previous to given time-references, i.e. before
TIME RELATERS
Adjectives earlier preceding
former previous
Adverbials already earlier/previous
prior first
so far before
formerly yet
before that up to now/then
before then In the beginning
until now/then (long) ago
Examples
1. The memory storage capacity of earlier computers was not as large as these days.
2. When the first digital computer was developed, the first analog computer had already been in
use for some time.
3. Up to now, computers have not created too much unemployment.
Table2:
Subsequent to time-reference, i.e. after
TIME RELATERS
Contemporary Simultaneous
at present meanwhile
at this point in the meantime
Adverbials
now when
today at the same time
for the time being
at the moment
Examples
1. Computers might be used in the future as simultaneous translating machines.
2. At present, computers are used for printing newspapers.
3. In future, computers will probably replace most of our daily activities, but in the meantime
scientists are still trying to develop computers to their full potential.
TIME RELATERS
Examples:
1. Since the development of the chip, computers have become cheaper and more compact.
2. You should have a good basic understanding of computers by the time you finish this reading
course.
3. After the development of transistors, the later computers were much faster.
34
N.B. Time sequence is also shown by different verb tenses.
Examples:
1. Vannevar Bush had built the first analog computer long before Professor Aiken and some men
at IBM invented the first digital computer.
2. At the rate computer technology is growing, computers, as we know them today, will soon
become obsolete.
Sample Paragraph
Computers, as we know them today, haven’t been around for a long time. It wasn’t until the
mid-1940s that the first working digital computer was completed. But since then, computers
84
VU
have evolved tremendously. Vacuum tubes were used in the first-generation computers at the
beginning of the 1960s. By the end of the 1960s, transistors were replaced by tiny integrated
circuit boards and, consequently, a new generation of computers was on the market. Fourth-
generation computers are now produced with circuits that are much smaller than before and fit
on a single chip. Soon, fifth-generation computers will be produced, and these will, no doubt, be
better than their predecessors.
Exercise
Read the following paragraph and as you read, underline the time relaters.
There are some who say that computers have a very short history but, because they are machines
that manipulate numbers, others disagree. More than 5000 years ago, a need to count was
recognized, and somebody had the idea of using first his fingers, then pebbles to keep track of
the count.
History is not clear as to whether the need was recognized before or after the idea occurred.
Since that time, the abacus was invented and some form of it was used well into the 16th century.
During the 17th and 18th centuries many easy ways of calculating were devised. Logarithm
tables, calculus and the basis for the modern slide rule were born out of that period of time. It
was not until the early 1800s that the first calculating machine appeared and not too long after,
Charles Babbage designed a machine which became the basis for building today’s computers.
A hundred years later the first analog computer was built, but the first digital computer was not
complete until 1944. Since then computers have gone through four generations from digital
computers using vacuum tubes in the 1950s, transistors in the early 1960s, integrated in the mid-
60s, and a single chip in the 190s. At the rate computer technology is growing now, we can
expect more changes in this field by the end of this decade.
Exercise (Answer)
Read the following paragraph and as you read, underline the time relaters.
There are some who say that computers have a very short history but, because they are machines
that manipulate numbers, others disagree. More than 5000 years ago, a need to count was
recognized, and somebody had the idea of using first his fingers, then pebbles to keep track of
the count.
History is not clear as to whether the need was recognized before or after the idea occurred.
Since that time, the abacus was invented and some form of it was used well into the 16th century.
During the 17th and 18th centuries many easy ways of calculating were devised. Logarithm
tables, calculus and the basis for the modern slide rule were born out of that period of time. It
was not until the early 1800s that the first calculating machine appeared and not too long after,
Charles Babbage designed a machine which became the basis for building today’s computers.
A hundred years later the first analog computer was built, but the first digital computer was not
complete until 1944. Since then computers have gone through four generations from digital
computers using vacuum tubes in the 1950s, transistors in the early 1960s, integrated in the mid-
60s, and a single chip in the 1970s. At the rate computer technology is growing now, we can
expect more changes in this field by the end of this decade.
Lesson -14
In today’s lesson, we are going to begin by looking at how writers bring their characters to life
by employing different descriptive and other techniques. In the second half, we will go back to
practical texts pertaining to your field of study – computers.
Characters: Almost every example of imaginative writing has to do with people in some way or
the other. We are going to look at some of the ways in which a writer is able to translate his
vision of the people. He is writing to the reader by means of words. In some ways, a painter or
photographer has an easier task since he is able to present his ideas directly to us in visual terms
though, of course, interpretation is necessary here, too. How, then, does an author achieve the
same effect by using only words? The writer achieves this effect by:
1. showing action.
2. putting actual words into characters’ mouth.
3. using direct statements.
4. making comparisons & associations.
5. associating with one particular point of view or action by which characters can easily and
quickly be identified.
6. choice of words and by picking out a particular feature or detail that calls the character vividly
to mind.
1. Action: One of the ways a writer does this is by showing the character performing some action
which is typical of him or performing an action in a particular way that reveals the kind of person
he is. Here is an example, a description of Pip’s sister, Mrs. Gargery, from Charles Dicken’s
Great Expectations.
My sister had a trenchant way of cutting our bread-and-butter for us that never varied. First, with
her left hand she jammed the load hard and fast against her bib-where it sometimes got a pin into
it, and sometimes a needle, which we afterwards got into our mouths. Then she took some butter
(not too much) on a knife and spread it on the loaf, in an apothecary kind of way, as if she were
making a plaster-using both sides of the knife with a slapping dexterity, and trimming and
molding the butter off round the crust. Then, she gave the knife a final smart wipe on the edge of
the plaster, and then sawed a very thick round off the loaf; which she finally, before separating
from the loaf, hewed into two halves, of which Joe got one, and I the other.
(CHARLES DICKENS, Great Expectations)
What does this account of Mrs. Gargery cutting bread tell us about her?
What impression does the use of words like ‘trenchant’ ‘jammed’, ‘slapping dexterity’, ‘a final
smart wipe’, ‘sawed’ and ‘hewed’ build up?
Write your answers to these questions in your notebook: it is a good practice.
2. Speech: Another way in which writers can indicate character is through the words they put
into their characters’ mouths. This is, of course, an important-possibly the most important-
86
VU
element of the dramatist’s art to reveal his characters through their speech, but writers employ
other devices as well.
Study the following passage from P.G. Wodehouse’s ‘Thank you, Jeeves’.
3. Direct Statements: Some writers tell us about their characters directly instead of showing
them and allowing us to draw our own conclusions. They build detail on detail until we have a
clear picture of their appearance, their habits, their opinions, and their life history. Here is an
account of a character called Miss Arkwright.
She was in no way a remarkable person. Her appearance was not particularly distinguished and
yet she was without any feature that could actively displease. She had enough personal
eccentricities to fit into the pattern of English village life, but none so absurd or anti-social that
they could embarrass or even arouse gossip beyond what was pleasant to her neighbors. She
accepted her position as an old maid with that cheerful good humor and occasional irony which
are essential to English spinsters since the deification of Jane Austen, or more sacredly Miss
Austen, by the upper middle classes, and she attempted to counteract the inadequacy of the
unmarried state by quiet, sensible and tolerant social work in the local community. She was liked
by nearly everyone, though she was not afraid of making enemies where she knew that her broad
but deeply felt religious principles were being opposed. Any socially pretentious or undesirably
extravagant conduct, too, was liable to call for her an unexpectedly caustic and well-aimed snub.
She was invited everywhere and always accepted the invitations. Quietly but well dressed, with
one or two very fine old pieces of jewellery that had come down to her from her grandmothers,
she would pass from one group to another, laughing or serious as the occasion demanded.
She listened with patience, but with a slight twinkle in her eye, to Mr Hodson’s endless stories
of life in Dar-es-Salaam or Myra Hop’s breathless accounts of her latest system of diet. John
Hobday in his somewhat ostentatiously gentleman-farmer attire would describe his next novel
about East Anglican life to her before, even, his beloved daughter had heard of it.
Richard Trelawney, just down from Oxford, found that she had read and really know Donne’s
sermons, yet she could swoop detective stories with Colonel Wright by the hour, and was his
main source for quotations when The Times cross-word was in question. It was she who
incorporated little Mrs. Grantham into village life, when that underbred, suburban woman came
there as Colonel Grantham’s second wife, checking her vulgar remarks about ‘the lower classes’
with kindly humor, but defending her against the formidable battery of Lady Vernon’s
antagonism. Yet, it was also she who was first at Lady Vernon’s when Sir Robert had his stroke
and her unobtrusive kindliness and real services gained her a singular position behind the grim
reserve of the Vernon family.
She could always banter the vicar away from his hobby horse of the Greek rite when at rural
community meetings the agenda seemed to have been buried forever beneath a welter of
Euchologia and Menaia. She checked Sir Robert’s anti-Bolshevik phobia from victimizing the
Country Librarian for her Fabianism but was fierce in her attack on the local council when she
thought that class prejudice had prevented Commander Osborne’s widow from getting council
house.
She led, in fact, an active and useful existence, yet when anyone praised her she would only
laugh-‘My dear’, she would say ‘hard work’s the only excuse old maids like me have got for
existing at all, and even then I don’t know that they oughtn’t to lethalize the lot of us.’ As the
danger of war grew nearer in the thirties, her favorite remark was ‘Well, if they've got any sense
this time they’ll keep the young fellows at home and put us useless old maids in the trenches,’
and she said it with real conviction.
(ANGUS WILSON, A Little Companion)
Now sum up in a few sentences the main points of Miss Arkwright’s character.
What are the reported comments that are typical of her character?
‘It was Miss Murdstone who arrived, and a gloomy-looking lady she was; dark, like her brother,
whom she greatly resembled in face and voice; and with very heavy eyebrows, nearly meeting
over her large nose, as if, being disabled by the wrongs of her kind from wearing whiskers, she
had carried them to that account.
She brought with her two uncompromising hard black boxes, with her initials on the lids in hard
brass nails. When she paid the coachman she took the money from a hard steel purse, and she
kept the purse in a very jail of a bag which hung upon her arm by a heavy chain, and shut up like
a bite. I had never, at that time, seen such a metallic lady altogether as Miss Murdstone was.’
(CHARLES DICKENS, David Copperfield)
Pick out the words or objects that directly suggest metal.
Which words in the description of Miss Murdstone do suggest characteristics of metal?
88
VU
5. Association of the Characters with One Particular Point of View or Action by Which
They can be Easily and Quickly Identified:
Who can ever forget, for instance, Uriah Heep in Charles Dickens’s David Copperfield being
‘ever so humble’ and rubbing his hands together, words and an action that are forever associated
with him? It was no fancy of mine about his hands, I observed; for he frequently ground the
palms against each other as if to squeeze them dry and warm, besides often wiping them, in a
stealthy way, on his pocket handkerchief.
Thomas Grandgrind, sir. A man of realities. A man of facts and calculations. A man who
proceeds upon the principle that two and two are four, and nothing over, and who is not to be
taled into allowing for anything over. Thomas Gradgrind, sir-peremptorily Thomas-Thomas
Gradgrind.
With a rule and a pair of scales, and the multiplication table always in his pocket, sir, ready to
weight and measure any parcel of human nature, and tell you exactly what it comes to. It is a
mere question of figures, a case of simple arithmetic. You might hope to get some other
nonsensical belief into the head of George Gradgrind, or Augustus Gradgrind, or John Gradgrind,
or Joseph Gradgrind (all suppositious, non-existent persons), but into the head of Thomas
Gradgrind-no sir!
(CHARLES DICKENS, Hard Times)
Underline the words that reinforce the idea that Thomas Gradgrind is a man of facts and
calculations. What does the use of word ‘sir’ add to the passage?
6. Choice of Words and Picking Out a Particular Feature or Detail That Calls the
Character Vividly to Mind:
Here are some examples taken from Edward Blishen’s ‘A Cackhanded War’:
‘He was a tiny fellow, with a leathery white face under black hair, and tied to the case he’d
brought were the most enormous gumboots I’d ever seen.’
‘Mrs. Goss was a widow, a neat little woman of over seventy: and witchlike.’
‘He was a deeply depressed man, this farmer, who always wore a white coat and cloth cap, and
was always peppered with a white-and-black bristle.’
‘He was a tall, silent, dark man, very gentle, who would tut over his machine as if it were some
moody woman.’ On the strawstack was a boy: a short, stout boy with a kind of naked pertness
about his eyes and a very runny nose.’
Describe five varied characters, using one sentence for each, and try to make them alive by the
way you use words or by giving to each a particular descriptive detail that defines him.
1. The switches, like the cores, are capable of being in one of two possible states that is, on or
off; magnetized or unmagnetized.
2. Computers have circuits for performing arithmetic operations such as: addition subtraction,
division, multiplication and exponentiation.
3. The computer can only decide three things, namely: Is one number less than another? Are two
numbers equal? Is one number greater than another?
4. Computers can process information at extremely rapid rates; for example, they can solve
certain arithmetic problems millions of times faster than a skilled mathematician.
5. Using the very limited capabilities possessed by all computers, the task of producing a
university payroll, for instance, can be done quite easily.
Not all texts present examples explicitly, some exemplifications are given implicitly, in which
case, the above markers are not used. With this we come to the end of this lesson. We have
looked at how writers use characterization in literary
90
VU
Lesson -15
Our experience is that after listening to an hour’s lecture, students begin very rapidly to forget
the information given to them. Twenty-four hours after the lecture, most of the students will have
forgotten 75% of the information. After forty-eight hours, the amount the students remember has
usually sunk to 15%. Yet, if the students review the information by noting the key points in the
first place and then reading over or discussing or using their notes, the retention levels are as
high as 70-85%.
Here you have been presented findings in words and numerals. Let’s put these findings into
graph form, so that you can ‘see’ them better.
Tables: The purpose of a table is to give the reader numerical information at a glance. They are
used to show various kinds of information in clear, compact columns. You are all familiar with a
time table. You had one in your school and college – it was a plan of the whole week – how
classes were scheduled. In the same way, you are familiar with airline and train time tables or
schedules. You are also familiar with tables in mathematics, physics, or chemistry. Tables are
useful for quick reference, but they require careful reading.
When you read a table:
(i) Read the title of the table first; it will tell you what information is shown in the table.
ii) Always look at the footnote given at the end or bottom of the table. It will explain or give
additional information that is necessary for an accurate interpretation of the data.
iii) Next, you must ask yourself if the information given in the table is reliable. For this, you
must check the source of information in the table.
iv) After that, look at the heading of each column. Be sure, you understand exactly what each
heading refers to and what is included in each column. Also notice the units that are used.
These could be in terms of numbers, money, weights, percentages, dates, sex, etc… The
units may also vary from column to column.
v) Finally, you must read the figures carefully and interpret them accurately.
Now look at the following table taken from R.C. Yorkey ‘Study Skills for Students of English’ p.
173 and mark the following statements as true (T) or false (F).
1. This table refers to the percentage of the total United States population. F
2. Judging from the table, the annual death rate has been reduced by slightly less than half
since 1900. T
3. Heart disease has consistently been the major cause of death. T
4. The death rate for infants in 1977 was 10.7 percent. T
5. Typhoid fever has been completely eliminated as a cause of death. F
6. Since 1940 the annual death rate for automobile accidents has remained about the same. T
7. The reduction in deaths since 1900 has been greater for tuberculosis than for pneumonia. T
8. The annual death rate for cancer was about 2½ times greater in 1977 than in 1900. T
9. The most serious childhood disease in the first part of the twentieth century apparently was
typhoid fever. T
10. The abbreviation n.a. means “Not Applicable”. T
Look at the following graph taken from R.C. Yorkey ‘Study Skills for Students of English’ p. 177
and answer the questions that follow. Answer the first five following questions by writing true
(T) or false (F) and the last five by writing the information.
92
VU
Bar Graphs: A bar graph is similar to a line graph except that the bars (extending from either the
vertical or the horizontal axis) are used instead of dots and lines. Look at the following bar graph
which is taken from R.C.Yorkey p. 178 that gives data from the world Almanac, 1979, and then
answer the questions that follow.
1. This graph shows the number of speakers of all the important languages of the world. T
2. The number of speakers is shown on the vertical axis. F
3. The number of speakers is indicated in millions e.g. 100 means 100,000,000. T
4. There are twice as many speakers of English as that of French. F
5. Two languages are spoken by more than 300 million speakers. T
Map Reading:
1. Japan is composed of four major islands. The biggest island is Honshu. What are the names
of the other ones? Kyushu, Shikoku, Hokkaido
2. Which island is the Northernmost? Hokkaido
3. Which island is the Southernmost? Kyushu
4. Japan is surrounded by an ocean and three seas. Name the ocean Pacific. Name the seas
Philippines Sea, Sea of Japan, East China Sea
5. Which sea is to the west of Japan? Sea of Japan
6. Which sea is to the southeast? Philippines Sea
7. What is the country nearest to Japan? South Korea How far is it from Japan? Approx. 150
km
8. What other countries are close to Japan? Russia, North Korea
9. Approximately how far are these countries from Japan? Closest: NK - 400 Km, Russia 300
Km
10. What direction are they from Tokyo? __East_
94
VU
11. How far is the island of Hokkaido from the Soviet Union? Approx. 300 Km
12. Which direction is Hokkaido from the Soviet Union? _North__
13. Which direction is Hokkaido from Korea? __ North West___
14. On Hokkaido, name one city that is due west of Kushiro: Sapporo and the one that is due
north of Hakodate: Sapporo
15. How many cities in Japan have a population of 1.000.000 or more? __6_____
a) What are their names? Osaka, Tokoyo Kobe, Kyoto, Nagoya, Yokohama.
b) How do you know which ones they are? Capitalized
16. Approximately how far is Nagoya from Tokyo? 390 Km Nagoya is to the East of Tokyo
and to the North East of Osaka.
True or False:
Study the charts again and say whether the following statements are ‘True’ or ‘False’.
A. In Asia the production of softwood timber is more important than the production of hardwood
timber. F
B. The largest ?? produces three times as much paper pulp as Europe. F
C. Asia produces three times as much paper pulp as Europe. F
D. The producers of timber are shown on the vertical axis of the graph. T
E. The cubic meters of wood produced are indicated in millions; for example, 50 mean
50,000,000 cubic meters. T
Making Comparisons
1. Formation: There are several ways of showing similarities or differences that exist
between or amongst things. The regular comparative and superlative of descriptive words,
whether these are adjectives or adverbs, are formed as follows:
2. By placing the words more and most in front of words with three or more syllables
Examples:
Absolute Comparative Superlative
Adjectives Interesting More interesting Most interesting
Convenient More convenient Most convenient
Beautiful More beautiful Most beautiful
Adverbs Easily More easily Most easily
Carefully More carefully Most carefully
3. Words with two syllables which end in –y or-ly, -ow, -le and -er can be given comparative
and superlative forms by adding the endings -er and -est respectively. Most of the remaining
words take more and most in front of them.
Examples:
Absolute Comparative Superlative
-y Happy Happier Happiest
funny Funnier Funniest
ly Early Earlier Earliest
Friendly Friendlier Friendliest
ow Shallow Shallower Shallowest
Narrow Narrower Narrowest
le Able Abler Ablest
Gentle Gentler Gentlest
er Clever Cleverer Cleverest
There are a small number of adjectives and adverbs that form the comparative and superlative
using a different stem. These irregular comparisons are as follows:
Examples:
Absolute Comparative Superlative
Adjectives Bad Worse Worst
Far Further/Farther Furthest/Farthest
Good Better Best
Many More Most
Adverbs Badly Worse Worst
Far Further/Farther Furthest/Farthest
Little Less Least
Much More Most
Well Better Best
2. Use in sentences: There are many reasons for using comparisons in discourse. They may be
used to show:
a. equivalence
b. non-equivalence
c. the superlative form
d. parallel increase
(a) Equivalence: The following words or constructions are used to show equivalence (i.e. the
similarity).
(b) Non-equivalence: The following words and/or constructions are used to show non-
equivalence.
not as … as greater than unequal (ly)
word + er than not as much… as unlike
more… than neither …nor …as not the same as
fewer … than not as many …as not all
less … than not equal to
Examples:
1. Learning a computer language is not as difficult as it seems.
2. A mainframe is bigger and more expensive than a microcomputer.
3. For less than $10,000, you could have a very good microcomputer.
4. Ten years ago, there were fewer computers in use than today.
5. Neither minicomputers nor microcomputers are very flexible.
6. Unlike minicomputers, microcomputers are not very flexible.
7. An analog computer is not the same as a digital computer.
8. Not all business have computerized their accounting departments.
(c) The superlative form: The following words and/or constructions are used to show one item
compared with others (i.e. the superlative).
Examples:
1. Computer technology is the fastest growing technology in the world today.
2. Digital computer programming is the most commonly used in data processing for business.
98
VU
(d) Parallel increase: The following words and/or constructions are used to show parallel
increase (i.e. two comparatives)
the (word + er), the more + word
the (word+er), the less + word
Examples:
1. The bigger the computer, the more complex the operations it can do.
2. The smaller the problem, the less challenging it is to the computer programmer.
Exercise 1
Decide whether each sentence expresses equivalence, non-equivalence, or the superlative,
then underline the words expressing the comparison.
1. Speeds for performing decision making operations are comparable to those for arithmetic
operations.
2. Even the most sophisticated computer, no matter how good it is, must be told what to do.
3. A computer can perform similar operations thousands of times, without becoming bored, tired
or even careless.
4. For example, modern computers can solve certain classes of arithmetic problems millions of
times faster than a skilled mathematician.
5. One of the most important reasons why computers are used so widely today is that almost
every big problem can be solved by solving a number of little problems.
6. Finally a computer, unlike a human being, has no intuition.
Exercise 1: Answer
Decide whether each sentence expresses equivalence, non-equivalence, or the superlative,
then underline the words expressing the comparison.
1. Speeds for performing decision making operations are comparable to those for arithmetic
operations. …equivalence
2. Even the most sophisticated computer, no matter how good it is, must be told what to do.
…superlative
3. A computer can perform similar operations thousands of times, without becoming bored, tired
or even careless. … equivalence
4. For example, modern computers can solve certain classes of arithmetic problems millions of
times faster than a skilled mathematician. …nonequivalence
5. One of the most important reasons why computers are used so widely today is that almost
every big problem can be solved by solving a number of little problems. …superlative
6. Finally a computer, unlike a human being, has no intuition. …non-equivalence
Exercise 2
Read the text on ‘Microcomputers’, and as you read, complete the table below by writing
the sentence or that part of the sentence from each paragraph that expresses a comparison.
This text is about the history of microcomputers, and how computers have evolved into the very
fast and efficient machines that they are today.
1- The early 1970s saw the birth of the microcomputer, or micro for short. The central processor
of the micro, called the microprocessor, is built as a single semiconductor device; that is, the
thousands of individual circuit elements necessary to perform all the logical and arithmetic
functions of a computer are manufactured as a single chip. A complete microcomputer system is
composed of a microprocessor, a memory and peripheral equipment.
The processor, memory and electronic controls for the peripheral equipment are usually put
together on a single or on a few printed circuit boards. Systems using microprocessors can be
hooked up together to dot the work that until recently only minicomputer systems were capable
of doing. Micros generally have somewhat simpler and less flexible instruction sets than minis,
and are typically much slower.
Different micros are available with 4-, 8-, 16- bit word lengths. Similarly, minis are available
with word lengths up to 32 bits. Although minis can be equipped with much larger primary
memory sizes, micros are becoming more powerful and converging with minicomputer
technology.
2- The extremely low price of micros has opened up entirely new areas of application for
computers. Only 20 years or so ago, a central processing unit of medium capability sold for a
few hundred thousand dollars (U.S.), and now some microprocessors sell for as cheaply as $10.
Of course, by the time you have a usable microcomputer system, the price will be somewhere
between $500 and $10,000 depending on the display unit, secondary storage, and whatever other
peripherals are needed.
3- The available range of microcomputer systems is evolving more rapidly than minicomputers.
Because of their incredibly low price, it is now possible to use only a small fraction of the
computer’s capability in a particular system application and still be far ahead financially of any
other way of getting the job done.
For example, thousands of industrial robots are in use today, and the number is growing very
rapidly as this relatively new industry improves the price and performance of its products by
using the latest microcomputers.
4- Even though the software available for most microcomputer systems is very-limited - more so
than for minis- it does not discourage their use in the many high-volume, fixed applications for
which programming is essentially a ‘one shot deal’ as is the case in the space shuttle program.
In addition to their extensive use in control systems of all types, they are destined for many new
uses from more complex calculators to automobile engine operation and medical diagnostics.
They are already used in automobile emission control systems and are the basis of many TV
game attachments. There is also a rapidly growing market for personal computers whose
application potential in education is only just beginning to be exploited.
5- It would seem that the limits for microcomputer applications have by no means been reached.
There are those who predict that the home and hobby computer markets will grow into a multi-
billion dollar enterprise within a decade or so. It would also appear that performance of
microprocessors could well increase ten-fold before 1990 while prices for micros could decrease
by as much.
100
VU
Answer:
Lesson -16
Evaluating Texts
One vital aspect of reading comprehension is the ability to assess and evaluate the text. This
means, first of all, that the reader should be fully aware of the writer’s intention of his point of
view, and possible bias. In order to evaluate a text, the student must be able to discriminate facts
from opinions. It is an important part of reading competence that the reader should be aware of
the way his judgment is influenced one way or another.
So far, you have had practice in distinguishing facts from opinions. In today's lesson you will
first have practice in distinguishing the writer’s Tone, and second, you will look at argumentation
– which is very central to the material that we read. Writers make a point and then support the
point. You as a successful reader must learn to recognize the point and recognize the support for
the point.
Tone: Look at the five statements expressing different attitudes about a ‘shabby house.’ Label
each statement by choosing the most appropriate tone from the word bank.
1. This may be a shabby, run-down looking house, but since I lived here in my
childhood it has a special place in my heart. (Sentimental)
2. This may not be the best looking house in the neighborhood, but it’s not really that bad.
(Tolerant)
3. If only I had a decent job, I wouldn’t be reduced to living in this ramshackle dump. (Bitter)
4. This place is in need of some costly renovation, and I expect the landlord to get around to
them any day now. (Optimistic)
5. When I leave this joint, I plan to empty rubbish bins of all the neighboring flats into it so I
can leave the place exactly as I found it. (Humorous)
Now I helped you in this exercise. See if you can do the next one on your own. But before you
do the next exercise, I must tell you something about IRONY. This is a commonly used tone and
the one which you may not be familiar with. When writing has an ironic tone, it says one thing
and means the opposite. Irony is found in everyday conversation as well as in writing. Irony
always involves ‘discrepancy’ – meaning that something doesn’t quite fit. It usually takes two
forms: situational and verbal.
(I) Situational irony occurs when the discrepancy lies in the situation itself. You expect
something but something else happens. Or a situation calls for an expected response but
something unexpected happens instead e.g. there is a house on fire and you expect the fire fighter
to aim a water hose/pipe at the fire, but instead he aims a petrol pipe/hose. That would be very
ironical.
102
VU
You may have heard of the situation in a play by the American playwright, William Inge’s ‘A
Social Event’ where the proud Hollywood couple is to be entertained. Afro-American maid has
an invitation to a special event to which the couple has NOT been invited: very ironical situation
indeed.
(II) Verbal irony occurs when there is discrepancy between what is said and what is meant –
usually the exact opposite or a near opposite of what is meant. For example, an eager cricket
player looks out of the window and sees that it is raining. “Oh, great!” he says, meaning exactly
the opposite. Another example to illustrate this: After seeing a terrible performance by an actor in
a movie someone might say “Now that’s an actor who is sure to win the Best Actor Award for
this year!” Both examples illustrate verbal irony.
Now you will look at three short passages each of which illustrates a tone given in the box.
Remember the tone reflects the author’s attitude. To find the tone of a paragraph, ask yourself
what attitude is revealed by its words and phrases.
(i) Research on rats has shown that when animals live in crowded conditions they live
disordered, violent lives. Human beings are no exception. Crowded cities are models of
lawlessness and the traffic-clogged roads encourage drivers to be aggressive. As urban areas
continue to grow in population density, these types of problems will also grow. That means more
violence and more fighting over available resources.
(ii) Those addicted to drugs probably feel terrible about themselves even if they don’t show it,
and harsh judgments only worsen their self-image. What these people need are programs to
rehabilitate them in society as well as help to rid themselves of their addictions. It is also
important that we should take a sympathetic view of their problem and open our hearts and
minds to these troubled persons.
(iii) When I hired Mughal Carpets to install a new wall-to-wall carpet in my drawing room, I
relied on the company’s reputation for quality work. However, I was deeply dissatisfied with the
dreadful job their workers did in my room. The carpet is poorly fitted as in one corner it is
creased while in the other the floor shows through. I am exasperated with the work of Mughal
Carpets and am thinking of asking my lawyer to sue them.
Argument: A good argument is one in which you make a point and then provide support
(persuasive and logical evidence) to back it up. For example, if you make the statement “My
neighbors are inconsiderate.”, we expect you to provide supporting details which would enable
others to see and judge whether your neighbors are really inconsiderate or not.
Now if you have added, “They play loud music at night, their children play and scream loudly
outside my house, and their dog barks all day long”, you have provided solid support to your
earlier statement “My neighbors are inconsiderate”.
In the following groups of statements, one statement is the point and the others are support for
the point.
Identify each point with (P) and identify each statement of support with (S).
I. Cats refuse to learn silly tricks just to amuse people. Cats seem to be more intelligent than
dogs. Dogs will accept mistreatment, but a cat if mistreated, it runs away.
2. If workers go on strike now, they will lose their jobs to replacement workers. Conditions in
factories are tougher than they used to be. In many industries workers have had to take wage
cuts.
3. Often you’ll have to wait half an hour for a route no. 5 bus, and then three will turn up at
once. Sometimes route no. 5 buses will drive past you at a bus stop, even though they aren’t full.
Route no.5 seems to be assigned the most ramshackle buses, ones that rattle and have broken
seats. Whenever possible, people should not ride the route no. 5 bus.
Types of Fallacies: In the first type – fallacies that ignore the issue you will find that the writer
may change the subject, or indulge in circular reasoning, or give way to personal attack, or may
create an imaginary opponent.
In the second type – fallacies that over generalize/oversimplify issue(s) you will find that the
writer may draw hasty conclusions on the basis of insufficient evidence, or assume that because a
certain event follows an earlier event, the subsequent event was the cause of the earlier event, or
may make false comparison or analogy, or the either-or-fallacy.
First, I will show you examples of unsound reasoning, then you will do a few exercises which
will give you practice in spotting them in your reading.
a) Changing the Subject: In this method of argument the writer tries to divert the audience’s
attention from the true issue by presenting evidence that has nothing to do with the argument.
For example, ‘The honorable member of the National Assembly is a capable leader. He has a
busy family life and prays daily in the area mosque.’ Mentioning about the member’s family life
and religious life sidesteps the issue of just how capable a member is.
104
VU
Exercise 1
The proposed new dam is going to be a disaster. The plans were drawn up nearly thirty years ago
when the affected area was lightly settled. Now, a generation later the area is thickly populated
and hundreds of families would be displaced if the dam is built. There are already many forces
working for the breakup of the family unit in Pakistan, these days. The environment will also be
negatively affected by the construction of the dam. Hundreds of birds will lose their natural
habitat and may die out.
a. Which sentence is not a sound argument in support of the author’s conclusion that the
proposed dam is a disaster?
b) Circular Reasoning: In this the supporting reason is the same as the conclusion. e.g. “Mr.
Abid is a great science teacher because he is so wonderful at teaching.” We do not know why Mr.
Abid is a great teacher. No real reasons are given – the statement merely repeats itself.
Exercise 2
Try to spot the circular reasoning in the following arguments.
1. Since persons under 18 are too young to vote. The voting age should not be lowered below
age 18.
2. Taking vitamin C is healthy, for it improves your well-being.
If you look closely at these arguments, you will notice that the reasons merely repeat an
important part of the conclusion. The careful reader wants to know the reason, supporting
evidence, not a repetition.
In the first argument, the author uses the idea that persons under 18 are too young to vote as the
conclusion and the reason of the argument. No real reason is advanced for why persons under 18
are too young to vote. In the second argument, the word healthy which is used in the conclusion
conveys the same idea as wellbeing. Conclusion and reason are used as one.
c) Personal Attack: This kind of fallacy often occurs in political debate. Here the issue under
discussion is ignored and the writer or speaker focuses attention on the opponent’s character. For
example,
“The Honorable Member of National Assembly views on the tax bill are not worthy of
consideration. His father also held similar views when he was a member of the assembly”.
As you can see from this example it ignores the issue - the tax bill – and concentrates on
personal character. It is always easy recognizing personal attack.
Exercise 3
Which one of the following statements contains an example of personal attack?
1. Our cricket team is not going to win the next World Cup. We have acquired the services of a
useless coach.
2. We should support the Zila Nazim’s proposal for tax collection. He has the biggest collection
of wealth by not paying the taxes.
3. The people who oppose the new traffic ticketing system are not concerned about traffic rules.
a) Hasty Generalization: This is a very common fallacy. A person who draws a conclusion on
the basis of insufficient evidence is making a hasty generalization. The following example will
make this amply clear.
The Iranians are a very stupid people as they have no talent for mathematics. Two Iranian boys
took math course with me once, and they were at the bottom of the class. Forming a conclusion
about a whole nation on the basis of two examples (boys) is an illogical jump.
Exercise
Three statements are given followed by four possible conclusions. Three of these are hasty
generalizations which cannot logically be drawn from the evidence given, and the fourth
one is a valid conclusion. Choose the one conclusion you think is valid.
1. The first time I went to the seaside at Karachi, my face got sun-burnt.
2. The second time I went to the seaside, I couldn’t swim because the water was too cold.
3. The third time I went to the seaside at Karachi; I stepped on a star fish and had to go hospital
to have the spikes removed from my foot.
Out of the four conclusions given which one would you choose as the most valid?
a) The seaside is unsafe & should be closed to the public.
b) The seaside is a polluted place.
c) I have had a series of bad experiences.
d) The seaside is not a place to visit.
Which one did you choose? Obviously the correct answer would be c.
b) False Cause: You have probably heard someone saying as a joke, “I know there is going to be
a dust storm today because I washed my hair”. Now the two events mentioned have no
connection whatsoever. Well that was just to tell you how often in life we make such wrong
associations – we assume cause-and-effect situations are not easy to analyze, as people tend to
oversimplify them by ignoring other possible causes. To identify an argument using a false cause,
look for alternate causes.
The Atlas Tyre Company was more prosperous before Mr. Hamid joined it as chairman. Clearly,
he is the cause of its decline.
106
VU
Exercise: Which one of the following statements contains an example of false cause?
1. You better get a job soon or face the fact that you are lazy and want to live off others.
2. Murree has terrible weather. I visited there for a week last July and it rained continuously.
3. After visiting my friend today, I came home with a headache. I must be allergic to his house.
(c) False Comparison: This is the third type of error in reasoning – when you assume that two
things are more alike than they really are. For instance read the following argument:
In our village we leave our doors unlocked all the time, so I don’t think it is necessary for you in
the city to have locks on your front door. To judge whether or not the above statement is a false
comparison consider if the two situations are alike. The two situations are not alike; one is in a
city where there may be a lack of security.
Exercise: Decide which one of the following statements contains an example of false
comparison.
1. You’ll either have to work hard at the job or face the fact that you’ll be turned out.
2. It doesn’t hurt your colleagues getting to work on foot and it won’t hurt you either.
3. Of course, ban on pillion riding will work in Pakistan. It’s worked in other countries, hasn’t it?
Exercise: Decide which one of the following statements contains an example of either-or
fallacy.
1. The maid-servant went off duty early, and then the gold bracelet was discovered missing, so
she must have stolen it.
2. Eat your apple, or you won’t grow up strong, and healthy.
3. As I don’t use a ballpoint pen to write so it’s not necessary for you to use one either.
In today’s lesson, we looked at different ways to develop effective reading and clear thinking and
these were: identifying purpose and tone and evaluating arguments. These were aimed at
developing advanced, critical levels of comprehension. In the next lesson we shall look at
another way of developing comprehension.
108
VU
Lesson -17
So far, the main reading activity that you have had practiced in has been the usual reading
comprehension. It required you to concentrate only on certain sections of the reading passage. In
this lesson, you will be introduced to another procedure for developing reading comprehension,
known as the CLOZE procedure.
What is this cloze procedure? A passage is selected from which words are deleted at regular
intervals. You, the reader, have to fill in the missing words. To fill the deletion, the learner
concentrates on a wider proportion of the text.
The deleted words usually comprise grammatical and lexical words and it is the student’s choice
of words to fill in the gaps that reveals his/her understanding of the passage as well as grasp of
the language.
The cloze has several points in its favour.
1. It encourages fluent reading.
2. It requires the reader to use a range of reading skills to complete the task.
3. It is thought provoking as it trains the student to explore within a semantic field or area for
related concepts
4. It trains the reader to look carefully at all structural clues
Cloze thus helps in developing the habit of concentrated reading, of going beyond the
immediate sentence for drawing meaning, in skimming to recap on what has been read and in
scanning for unspecified information in order to predict.
The cloze is essentially a cognitive/mental task which requires the completion of meaning based
on understanding and reason. It involves the reader in active interaction with the text to predict
the missing word while making use of context clues. Once you have grasped the basic techniques
you will begin to enjoy it as a guessing game - not wild guesses, but informed guesses. Look at
the following passage so that you get a rough idea of what it is about.
Notice the first two sentences and the last sentence does not have any gaps. This is to help you
understand the overall meaning of the passage.
- Discuss the context of the passage.
- Each gap stands for just ONE word that is missing.
- Explain why certain words are appropriate.
- A word can only be accepted if it fits in the context without changing the
meaning of the passage.
Exercise 1
A good education should, among other things, train you to think for yourself. The examination
system does anything but that. What has to be learnt 1____ strictly laid down by 2 _____
syllabus, so the student 3____ ___ only what is prescribed. Examinations 4 ______ not motivate
a student 5______ read widely; they 6_____ his reading. They do 7__ encourage him to seek
8______ knowledge; they narrow the 9______ of study.
They lower 10_____ standards of teaching, for 11______ deprive the teacher of 12_____
freedom. Teachers themselves are 13___ judged by examination by results, 14_____ instead of
teaching their 15, _____ they are reduce to 16____ their students in the 17______ of taking
examinations which 18______ despise. The most successful 19_______ are not always the
20_____ educated. They are merely the best trained in the technique of working under stress and
strain.
Answer:
Exercise 1
A good education should, among other things, train you to think for yourself. The examination
system does anything but that. What has to be learnt 1__ is__ strictly laid down by 2 ___the__
syllabus, so the student 3____does / learns___ only what is prescribed. Examinations 4
___do___ not motivate a student 5___to___ read widely; they 6___restrict / curb__ his reading.
They do 7__not__ encourage him to seek 8___further / more___ knowledge; they narrow the
9___field___ of study. They lower 10__the___ standards of teaching, for 11___they___ deprive
the teacher of 12___all / his / her___ freedom. Teachers themselves are 13__often__ judged by
examination by results, 14__so / and___ instead of teaching their 15, __subjects___ they are
reduce to 16__training__ their students in the 17___art/technique___ of taking examinations
which 18___they___ despise. The most successful 19__students___ are not always the
20__best___ educated. They are merely the best trained in the technique of working under stress
and strain.
Exercise 2
Global warming is by no means a new phenomenon: it has been around since the creation of
Planet Earth itself. At first, the process was beneficial: it brought Earth out of the ice ages into a
time when humanity could survive on it. Now, however, it has become a problem. 1 ____ has
happened in 2 _____ ways, the ‘runway’ 3 ______effect and ozone 4 _____depletion. This is 5
____ the greenhouse effect 6 ______: ordinarily energy from 7____ Sun reaches the 8 _____ and
is reflected 9 _____ into space, but 10 ____ greenhouse gases forming layer around the planet,
the reflection process cannot take place and the energy is trapped, heating up the atmosphere.
(Saifullah & Ismail)
Exercise 2
Global warming is by no means a new phenomenon: it has been around since the creation of
Planet Earth itself. At first the process was beneficial: it brought Earth out of the ice ages into a
time when humanity could survive on it. Now, however, it has become a problem. 1 This has
happened in 2 two ways, the ‘runway’ 3 greenhouse effect and ozone 4 layer depletion. This is 5
how the greenhouse effect 6 works: ordinarily energy from 7 the Sun reaches the 8 Earth and is
reflected 9 back into space, but 10 with greenhouse gases forming layer around the planet, the
reflection process cannot take place and the energy is trapped, heating up the atmosphere.
(Saifullah & Ismail)
These were samples of regular, standard type of cloze where the gaps/blanks occur after a fixed
number of words and these blanks may be filled with any word that is appropriate in terms of
110
VU
linguistic and contextual criteria. There are many variations of the standard cloze. Now, I shall
pace you through some alternative forms.
My dear children,
It’s hard to believe that I’ve been here for a month. The time passes so quickly and there’s so
much to do. I’ve managed to see all the members of the family. I 1 ______as much time as I can
with the children. Last week I 2 ____-Mark and Michelle to the circus. 3 ______never been
before as they live quite far from the nearest city and their parents 4 _____ have time to drive
them there. I 5 ________ that’s what grandmothers are for. At any 6 _____ Susan lent me her car
- it’s a brand 7 _____ bright red Mini. We left early in the morning so as to make a day of 8
____. In the morning we 9 _____ to the zoo and in the afternoon to the circus. As 10 _____can
imagine, the children were very excited. They loved everything. Mark 11 _____ the wild animals
the most exciting and Michelle is 12 _____ to be an acrobat when she grows 13______.
After we’d been there for about two hours we 14 ______ an announcement over the loudspeaker.
The owner of the red Mini, number PUR 727V, 15 ______ requested to come to the manager’s
office 16 _________. Naturally, I didn’t know the number of 17 ___________ car so I left the
children and went to the manager’s office to 18 _____ out if it was our car.
The manager looked very upset and 19______________________. No one else had answered his
call so I assumed correctly that it was Susan’s car. 20___________________that I’d left the
lights on, or parked in 21 ________way, I wasn’t 22 ________concerned, but I didn’t know why
the manager looked so disturbed. He began to 23 _________what happened and it took me some
time to understand 24 ______confused explanation.
25 ____appears that the elephants are trained to sit on red boxes. One of the elephants 26
_____escaped and when he saw the 27 ______red car he promptly sat on 28______! As you can
imagine the car looked a mess. One side was squashed 29 ________but it was still possible to
drive. The manager assured 30 _____that the circus would pay for the 31________. He couldn’t
have been more apologetic.
The children were very 32 _______ and giggled about the incident all the way home. 33
__________before we got there, we 34 _________the scene of a serious accident. About a mile
35 _______on a policeman stopped us and asked if we’d 36 _________involved in the accident.
I wish I had a 37 _______of his face when I told him what had happened 38 ______the car.
I think he wanted to arrest me for drunken driving! Fortunately the 39 ______were there to back
me up.40 ______are you managing without me? please don’t 41 ______to water my plants. I’m
planning to leave here 42____ the end of the month.
Mom
(Cloze in Class: Moller & Whiteson)
Answer:
Exercise 3 Selected Deletion Cloze
Notice the blanks are not after a fixed number of words.
My dear children,
It’s hard to believe that I’ve been here for a month. The time passes so quickly and there’s so
much to do. I’ve managed to see all the members of the family. I 1 spend as much time as I can
With the children. Last week I 2 took Mark and Michelle to the circus. 3 They’d never been to
one before as they live quite far from the nearest city and their parents 4 never have time to drive
them there. I 5 suppose / think that’s what grandmothers are for.
At any 6 rate Susan lent me her car - it’s a brand 7 new bright red Mini. We left early in the
morning so as to make a day of 8 it.
In the morning we 9 went to the zoo and in the afternoon to the circus.
As 10 you can imagine, the children were very excited. They loved everything. Mark 11 found
the wild animals the most exciting and Michelle is 12 going to be an acrobat when she grows 13
up.
After we’d been there for about two hours we 14 heard an announcement over the loudspeaker.
The owner of the red Mini, number PUR 727V, 15 was requested to come to the manager’s office
16 immediately. Naturally, I didn’t know the number of 17 the / Susan’s car so I left the children
and went to the manager’s office to 18 find out if it was our car.
The manager looked very upset and 19 embarrassed / disturbed. No one else had answered his
call so I assumed correctly that it was Susan’s car. 20 Imagining / Thinking / Fearing / Assuming
that I’d left the lights on, or parked in 21 someone’s way, I wasn’t 22 too / very concerned, but I
didn’t know why the manager looked so disturbed. He began to 23 explain what happened and it
took me some time to understand 24 his confused explanation.
25 It appears that the elephants are trained to sit on red boxes. One of the elephants 26 had
escaped and when he saw the 27 little red car he promptly sat on 28 it! As you can imagine the
car looked a mess. One side was squashed 29 badly / flat but it was still possible to drive. The
manager assured 30 me that the circus would pay for the 31 damage. He couldn’t have been
more apologetic.
The children were very 32 amused and giggled about the incident all the way home. 33 Just / But
before we got there, we 34 passed the scene of a serious accident. About a mile 35 further on a
policeman stopped us and asked if we’d 36 been involved in the accident. I wish I had a 37
picture of his face when I told him what had happened 38 to the car.
I think he wanted to arrest me for drunken driving! Fortunately the 39 children were there to
back me up.
40 How are you managing without me? Please don’t 41 forget to water my plants. I’m planning
to leave here 42 at the end of the month.
Mom.
112
VU
Over population is one of the most serious problems facing the world today. The world’s
exploding population -----------------, even more growing pains --------------- for already
crowded areas. ---------------new United Nations study ------------- that by the year-----
five billion persons will -----------------added to the 6.5 ________in the world today. ---------------
---more troubling than the-----------------number of inhabitants are ---------------estimate of where
they will be concentrated. (Advanced Reading Skills)
Over population is one of the most serious problems facing the world today. The world’s
exploding population experiences, signals, predicts, even more growing pains before, now, ahead
for already crowded areas. The, Some, A new United Nations study signals, forecasts, tells that
by the year 2000, 2001, 2015 five billion persons will have, be, not be added to the 6.5 billion,
million, thousand in the world today. Even, Far, No more troubling than the big, small,
increasing number of inhabitants is
an, the, estimate of where they will be Concentrated.
(Advanced Reading Skills)
Markstein & Hirasawa
The world’s exploding population
Oliver is a film about an orphan 1 _____ . The story 2 _______ Charles Dickens, the famous
novelist. It 3 ________ in England during the 4__________. Oliver, 5________ escapes from a
workhouse and 6_________ London. 7__________ he meets the villian, Bill Sykes, and Nancy,
his girlfriend, the pickpocket, artful Dodger, and Fagin, the old beggar.
8___________, the beggar and the pickpocket teach him 9_________ to survive, but then the
police. 10________ The judge lets him 11____________ with his uncle, Mr. Brown Low, a
12__________ man. 13___________ Bill Sykes is killed, and Oliver goes to 14_____________
happily 15___________ uncle. It’s such an 16_________ and 17__________ story about a boy’s
18___________ for 19________ that nobody should 20______.
This is an advanced level exercise. Here a word is omitted from each line/sentence without a
blank marked on the page. You are required to first mark the place where you think the word has
been omitted with a stroke (/), and then write the word that has been omitted in the right hand
margin. The first two have been done for you. There are ten insertions to be made.
114
VU
Lesson-18
In this lesson, we will be looking at a reading text which will talk about primary and secondary
memory in a computer. We are following the same pattern as established earlier. You are required
to listen carefully as I read the text and then together we will do the exercises that follow the
reading passage(s).
[2] Primary memory is closely associated with the CPU because it stores programs and data
temporarily, thus making them immediately available for processing by the CPU. To facilitate
processing, two things are needed: random access and speed. The former means that any part of
the memory may be read, or accessed, equally quickly. This is made possible by the system of
addresses in primary memory, where the storage locations are like a series of tiny compartments,
each having its own address.
These addresses are like the addresses of houses, in that they do not change. Because they are
always fixed, the control unit knows where to find them at a very high speed. When it finds
them, it puts into the compartments whatever must go there and wipes out whatever was stored
there. The information present in these compartments is called the contents of the memory.
[3] Most primary memory is costly, and therefore it is used transiently, which means that a
program, or parts of it, is kept in internal storage while the program is being executed. This,
however, is not true for mini and micro applications where the computer performs the same
function, referred to as a dedicated function, all the time. But since computers must process vast
quantities of data and programs, a lot of storage space is required. For this reason various
secondary memory technologies have been developed.
[4] Secondary memory devices fall into two categories: sequential devices and random-access
devices. Sequential devices permit information to be written onto or read off some storage
medium in a fixed sequence only. In order to get at a particular data item, it is necessary to pass
over all the data preceding it. An example of such a device is the magnetic tape. Its cost is low,
but access to specified data may take a considerable length of time.
On the other hand, random-access devices are designed to permit direct, or almost direct, access
to specified data. These devices bypass large quantities of irrelevant data and therefore reduce
access time considerably. An example of this technology is the magnetic disk, which is faster
than the magnetic tape and also more expensive. When disks are hooked up to the computer and
used as an extension of internal storage in order to increase the capacity of primary memory, this
is called virtual storage. For example, a computer with 256K bytes of real storage may seem to
have 512K bytes of virtual storage by using disks to provide additional storage.
1. Main Idea:
Which statement best expresses the main idea of the text? Why did you eliminate the other
choices?
1. There are two types of memory: primary and secondary.
2. Primary memory is more important than secondary memory.
3. Secondary memory devices are unimportant in a computer system.
Answer
1. Main Idea of the Passages
The text mentions that primary memory is very costly.
It doesn’t state that it is more important than secondary memory; neither does it state that the
later is unimportant in a computer system.
5. The control unit needs to know the location where information is stored or needs to be
stored. NS
8. Information stored on magnetic disk can be retrieved faster than if that same information
was on tape. S
10. Computers can process information even if complete programs are not put in internal
storage. NS
116
VU
3. Locating Information
Find the passages in the text where the following ideas are expressed. Give the paragraph
reference.
………. 1 Speed and random access are important in processing information.
………. 2 Random-access devices are more efficient than sequential devices.
………. 3 The CPU and primary memory work closely together.
………. 4 Virtual storage increases the memory capacity of a computer.
………. 5 Real storage, internal storage, and primary memory are all the same
………. 6 Information is stored in memory in compartments with a specific location.
………. 7 There are two classes of secondary memory device.
……….8 Only parts of programs are kept in primary storage while a program is being run
through.
Answer:
3. Locating Information
Find the passages in the text where the following ideas are expressed. Give the paragraph
reference.
Para 2…….1 Speed and random access are important in processing information.
Para 4…….2 Random-access devices are more efficient than sequential devices.
Para 2…….3 The CPU and primary memory work closely together.
Para 4…….4 Virtual storage increases the memory capacity of a computer.
Para 1…….5 Real storage, internal storage, and primary memory are all the same
Para 2…….6 Information is stored in memory in compartments with a specific location.
Para 4…….7 There are two classes of secondary memory device.
Para 3……8 Only parts of programs are kept in primary storage while a program is being run
through.
4. Contextual Reference
Look back at the text and find out what the words in bold typeface refer to.
1. It is also called ………...
2. Depending on their ………... storage capacity
3. Thus making them ………...
4. The former means that ………..
5. Where the storage ……….. locations
6. Each having its own ……… address
7. In that they do not ……... change
8. Where to find them ……….
9. Whatever must go there ……….
10. Or parts of it ……….
Answer:
Contextual Reference
Look back at the text and find out what the words in bold typeface refer to.
1. It is also called (p.1)… memory
……...
5. Understanding Words
Refer back to the text and find synonyms for the following words.
1. Represented ………...
2. Erases ………...
3. Carried out ………...
4. Before ………...
5. Very much ………...
Answer:
Refer back to the text and find synonyms for the following words:
1. Represented (p.1)… Expressed
2. Erases (p.2)… Wipes out
3. Carried out (p.3)… Executed
4. Before (p.4)… Preceding
5. Very much (p.4)… Considerably
Now refer back to the text and find antonyms for the following words.
6. Latter ………...
7. Disallow ………...
8. Unnecessary ………...
9. Go through ………...
10. Imaginary ………...
Answer:
6. Latter … former
7. Disallow … permit
8. Unnecessary … required
9. Go through … bypass
10. Imaginary … real
D
118
VU
6. Word forms
First choose the appropriate form of the words to complete the sentences. Then check the
differences of meaning in your dictionary.
7. Content Review
Match the words in column A with the words or statements in column B.
1. Internal storage a. means any part of memory can be read equally quickly
d
f 2. Real storage b. the information contained in the storage locations
120
VU
8. Focus Review
We learnt in earlier lesson how to use examples to explain a point or to illustrate an idea in a
given text. It is important to learn to differentiate between the idea and the illustration of the idea
with examples. Writers often say explicitly which things are examples by using connectives like
for example, such as, etc...
9. Adding Information
There are many reasons why people read, but in an academic setting, reading is primarily done to
get information on a particular subject. It is important for the reader to understand the
relationship between the information given and the information which preceded it. Often
information is presented in such a way as to suggest a REINFORCEMENT of what has been
said, or to show a SIMILARITY to what has been said before.
When writers give explanations about something, they usually offer examples to support their
argument in favor of a particular viewpoint. They may choose to present the information
DEDUCTIVELY, in which case a generalization is given first and then examples are given in
support of the general statement or principle. Others prefer to provide examples first, and then
make the generalization. This form of presentation is called INDUCTIVE reinforcement.
Reinforcement
1. In addition to their speed, computers are accurate and can do repetitive operations over and
over without becoming tired or bored.
2. Microcomputers are cheaper than mainframes, as well as compact and portable.
Similarity
2. Microcomputers can have a storage capacity of up to 32K, like minicomputers.
3. Many minicomputers, much the same way as is the case in automobile emission control, are
used merely for a fixed application and run only a single program.
Lesson -19
In today’s lesson, you are going to read about types of memory to be found in a computer. We
will follow the usual pattern of reading followed by comprehension exercises, scanning for
information, vocabulary and content review exercises. This will be followed by exercises on how
language functions operate in English.
Types of memory
[1] As mentioned previously, one of the most important characteristics of a computer is its
capability of storing information in its memory long enough to process it. Not all computers have
the same type of memory. In this section, three types of memory will be discussed: core memory,
semiconductor memory (or chip), and bubble memory.
[2] The memory of the first computers was made up of a kind of grid of fine vertical and
horizontal wires. At each intersection where the wires crossed, there was a small ferrite ring
called a core (hence the name ‘core memory’) which was capable of being either magnetized or
demagnetized. Every intersection had its unique address; consequently, when an electrical
current was passed through the wires, the magnetized as well as the unmagnetized cores were
identified by their respective addresses.
(2a] Each core represented a binary digit of either 0 or 1, depending on its state. Early computers
had a capacity of around 80,000 bits; whereas now, it is not surprising to hear about computers
with a memory capacity of millions of bits. This has been made possible by the advent of
transistors and by the advances in the manufacture of miniaturized circuitry. As a result,
mainframes have been reduced in both size and cost. Throughout the 1950s, 1960s and up to the
mid-1970s, core memory dominated the market.
[3] In the 1970s, there was a further development which revolutionized the computer field. This
was the ability to etch thousands of integrated circuits onto a tiny piece (chip) of silicon, which is
a non-metallic element with semiconductor characteristics. Chips have thousands of identical
circuits, each one capable of storing one bit because of the very small size of the chip, and
consequently of the circuits etched on it, faster.
[3a] Moreover, the size of the components containing the circuitry can be considerably reduced,
a step which has led to the introduction of both minis and micros. As a result, computers have
become smaller, faster, and cheaper. There is one problem with semiconductor memory,
however: when power is removed, information in the memory is lost-unlike core memory, which
is capable of retaining information during a power failure.
122
VU
4] Another development in the field of computer memories is bubble memory. The concept
consists of creating a thin film of metallic alloys over the memory board. When this film is
magnetized, it produces magnetic bubbles, the presence or absence of which represents one bit of
information. These bubbles are extremely tiny, about 0.1 micrometers in diameter.
[4a] Therefore, a magnetic bubble memory can store information at a greater density than
existing memories, which makes it suitable for micros. Bubble memories are not expensive;
consume little power, small in size, and highly reliable. There is probably a lot more to learn
about them, and research in this field continues.
1. Main Idea
Which statement does not express the main idea of the text?
1. The most important function of a computer is to hold information in its memory in order to
process it. T
2. Minicomputers, microcomputers, and mainframes all have the same kind of memory. T
3. Semiconductor memory was developed before core memory and after bubble memory. F
4. Core memory uses small metal rings which can be magnetized or unmagnetized. T
6. Early computer memories had less storage capacity than newer ones. T
3. Locating Information
Find the passages in the text where the following ideas are expressed. Give the line references.
……p1…….1. First there is core memory.
……p3…….2. Further to this development, chips evolved.
……p1…… 3. There are three types of memory board.
4. Contextual Reference
Look back at the text and find out what the words in bold typeface refer to.
5. Understanding Words
Refer back to the text and find synonyms for the following words.
1. Said (1.1)…………mentioned...
2. Own (1.2)…………...respective…
3. Progress (1.17)…………...advances….
4. Keeping (1.33)…………...retaining….
5. Appropriate (1.42)…………...suitable…..
Now refer back to the text and find antonyms for the following words.
6. Words Forms
First choose the appropriate form of the words to complete the sentences. Then check the
differences of meaning in your dictionary.
124
VU
7. Content Review
Use the information in the text on ‘Types of Memory’ to complete the table.
2. Integrated circuits on
non-metallic element
3.
8. Focus Review
‘Means’ by We mean*
A chip is defined as a tiny square piece of silicon upon which several layers of an integrated
circuit are etched or imprinted, after which the circuit is encapsulated in plastic, ceramic, or
metal.
126
VU
2. There are other methods used to define or explain, depending on the style used. One very
common method is to give the term being defined and say what it is without repeating the
term, i.e. X is/are Y.
Examples:
A computer is an electronic device.
Tapes and disks are memory devices.
Printers are output devices.
3. Another very common method is to use the same pattern as in 2 above and also give some
distinguishing characteristics.
Examples:
A computer is an electronic device which/that processes information.
Tapes and disks are memory devices which/that can be stored away for future use.
A programmer is a person who prepares programs to solve problems.
N.B. The relative pronouns used in this type of definition will be who or that for people, when
for a period of time, where for place or location, and that or which for things.
4. One of the most frequent forms of definition or explanation is to use two nouns (or noun
phrases) in apposition, separated by commas.
Examples:
Computers, electronic devices for processing information, are now used in practically every
aspect of life.
Systems software, programs, directs the computer to perform tasks.
Turnkey systems, complete hardware/software products, may be provided along with the
hardware by a systems supplier.
Exercise 1
Study the following definitions. A definition usually includes all three parts: the term to be
defined, the group it belongs to, and the characteristics which distinguish it from other members
of the group.
Now analyze the following definitions and identify the different parts by highlighting the
term; by underlining the group once, and by underlining the characteristics twice.
1. A computer is a machine with an intricate network of electronic circuits that operate switches
or magnetize tiny metal cores.
© Copyright Virtual University of Pakistan 127
VU
2. An abacus is a bead frame in which the beads are moved from left to right.
3. Input is the information presented to the computer.
4. The term computer includes those parts of hardware in which calculations and other data
manipulations are performed, and high-speed internal memory in which data and calculations
are stored during actual executions of programs.
5. A system is a good mixture of integrated parts working together to form a useful whole.
6. Large computer systems, or mainframes, as they are referred to in the field of computer
science, are those computer systems fund in computer installations processing immense
amounts of data.
7. Although there is no exact definition for a minicomputer, it is generally understood to refer to
a to a computer whose mainframe is physically small, has a fixed word length between 8 and
32 bits, and costs less than $100,00 for the central processor.
128
VU
Lesson -20
In today’s lesson, you are going to read about Steps in Problem Solving. We will follow the
usual pattern of reading followed by comprehension exercises, scanning for information,
vocabulary and content review exercises. This will be followed by exploring the ‘Cause Effect
Relationship’ between texts and working with language for ‘Classifying’ in English.
Step 3: The programmer must translate the algorithm or flowchart into a computer program. To
do so, he or she writes detailed instructions for the computer, using one of the many computer
languages available and following the exact sequence of the flowchart algorithm. The program is
usually written on coding sheets which have a specific format drawn on them.
Step 4: The programmer must then keypunch the program, or give the coding sheets to the
keypunch operator to do it. The program is either punched on cards or entered into the computer
at a terminal with a visual display unit.
Step 5: The program must then be tested. To do so, the computer operator puts the deck of cards
in the card reader and presses the ‘read’ button. This transfers the information to the memory of
the computer. Next, a printout shows if the program works or if it has errors (called bugs). If the
programmer is using a terminal instead of cards to enter the instructions it is possible, with the
aid of a few commands, to store the program in the memory of the computer and get a printout.
Step 6: The last step is to add the data to the program and run the job completely. The computer
will then perform the calculations necessary to solve the problem. It will follow the instructions
in the program to the minutest details. Therefore, one can say that the computer is a robot. It
doesn’t think, but simply does what it is told.
Exercises
1. Main Idea
Which statement best express the main idea of the text? Why did you eliminate the other
choices?
1. Constructing an algorithm is the basic step in solving a problem.
2. Solving problems becomes easier if certain steps are followed.
3. The computer does what the programmer tells it to do.
3. Locating Information
Find the passages in the text where the following ideas are expressed. Give the paragraph
references.
…P4….. 1. Programs are usually written on certain lined forms.
…P3…… 2. A block diagram can show decisions with two different outcomes.
…P1…… 3. The programmer is the one who solves the problems.
…P6…… 4. Even if the programmer is using a terminal instead of cards, it is possible to get
permanent copy of his program.
…P2……5. Not all problems are of the same level of difficulty.
4. Contextual Reference
Look back at the text and find out what the words in bold typeface refer to.
1. It is a machine (l.1)…computer………..
2. Which the programmer gives it (l.2)…procedure…..….
3. Who solves the problems (l.3)…programmer.…..
4. Which may be stated (l.14)…flow chart…….
5. The latter is a diagrammatic representation (l.15)…blocked diagram…….…
6. Operate to do it (l.27)…key punch the program
7. This transfers the information (l.32)…reading cards through card
readers
130
VU
5. Understanding Words
Refer back to the text and find synonyms for the following words.
1. Construct (l.10)……formulate………………
2. Takes a lot of time (l.13)…………time consuming…………
3. Exact (1.15)…………precise…………
4. Mistakes (l.34) ………………bugs……
5. Help (l.35)………………aids…….
Now refer back to the text and find antonyms for the following words.
6. Ambiguously (l.5)………clearly…………..
7. Specific (l.6)……general……………..
8. Partially (l.39)………completely…………
6. Word Forms
First choose the appropriate form of the words to complete the sentences. Then check the
differences of meaning in your dictionary.
4. Code, coding
a. Do you have any …coding……………………….. Sheet left.
b. I have to ……………code……………. my program.
1. Special forms which are usually used for writing programs are called …coding
sheets…………….
2. Another word for program errors is…………bugs…..
3. A number of steps used in solving a program is called a …algorithms………………..
4. A machine which is incapable of thinking but follows instructions is called a
…robot…………..
5. A ……………flow chart…………… is either a group of exact sentences to solve a problem
or a block diagram.
132
VU
8. Focus Review
Focus On: Cause and effect/result
The following sentences were taken from the text on ‘Steps in Problem Solving’. While reading
these sentences underline the cause once, the effect/result twice, then circle the causal-
effect/result marker.
1. If the programmer is using a terminal instead of cards to enter his instructions, he can, with the
aid of a few commands, store the program in the memory of the computer and get a printout.
2. The computer will follow the instructions in the program to the minutest details. Therefore,
one can say that the computer is a robot.
Classifying
The term ‘classification’ means to separate objects from one another. The simplest classification
divides things into those that show groups of characteristics that are shared and those that are
not. For example, one would not place fish and birds together in the same class with trees.
Classification usually goes from general to specific and is essential in attempting to make sense
out of things around us.
Classification, then, is a process of bringing order out of confusion by breaking down the general
topic into its related parts in a logical way. Outlining is very closely related to classification,
because it organizes information in a logical fashion, going from general to specific, or from
least important to most important, or from specific to general.
is is made up of
is of comprises
has consists of
includes
A general to specific classification will usually have singular main verbs, unless two or more
things are being analyzed simultaneously.
Examples:
1. The CPU is divided into three parts: the control unit the arithmetic-logical unit, and
memory.
1. The CPU has three parts: the control unit, the arithmetic-logical unit, and memory.
2. The CPU includes three parts: the control unit, the arithmetic-logical unit, and
memory.
3. The CPU is made up of three parts: the control unit, the arithmetic-logical unit, and
memory.
4. The CPU is composed of three parts: the control unit, the arithmetic-logical unit, and
memory.
5. The CPU consists of three parts: the control unit, the arithmetic-logical unit, and
memory.
Example:
The CPU is made up of the control unit, the arithmetic-logical unit and memory (from general to
specific).
Not: ‘The CPU makes up the control unit, the arithmetic-logical unit, and memory.’
Not: ‘The control unit, the arithmetic-logical unit, and memory are made up of the CPU.’
Finally, understanding classification is important for understanding and recognizing definitions.
Exercise 1
A computer has four basic components: input, processor, memory, and output. The CPU consists
of two parts: the …………control unit…………. which directs and controls the signals and
commands inside the processor, and the ………arithmetic-logical…………... unit which does
the arithmetic operations and the decision-making operations. While the …control
unit………….….……is made up of a ………register…….……., a ………decoder………….,
a……counter………………. and a…………clock……………, the …ALU………………….. is
composed of ……registers………….., a………binary adders…………. and
…circuitry……………..,which compares information and makes decision based on the results
of the comparisons.
In a computer, internal memory or ……primary memory……………… refers to the storage
location inside the computer, whereas………secondary memory……………. refers to the
storage embodied in the peripherals…………core……….. can be divided into three
types:……chip……………………., ………………… and ………bubble………… on the other
134
VU
Exercise 2
Using the diagram below, complete the paragraph that follows.
A
computer system
CPU
A computer has four basic Components: input, processor, memory, and output. The CPU consists
of two parts: the _____________which directs and controls the signals and commands inside the
processor, and the________ unit which does the arithmetic operations and the decision making
operations. While the _____is made up of a _____ a_________, a ________, and a
____________,the__________ is composed of __________, a _______and________, which
compares information and makes decisions based on the results of the comparisons.
In a Computer internal memory or _______ refers to the storage locations inside the computer,
whereas ______refers to the storage embodied in the peripherals __________ can be divided into
three types: ____________ , ______________ and_______________ .
_______ on the other hand may be grouped as _____________ ( _______) or _______ (
________ ).
The __________ devices can be either a _________, a ______, a _______ or a
______________.
These Devices enter in information into the computer. After the processor has operated on it, the
______ devices display the results of the computations on either a ______ or a __________, or
store them on tape or disk for future use.
Answer:
A computer has four basic components: input, processor, memory, and output. The CPU consists
of two parts: the Control unit which directs and controls the signals and commands inside the
processor, and the arithmetic- logical which does the arithmetic operations and the decision
making operations. While the Control unit is made up of a register, a decoder, a counter, and a
clock, the_ ALU_ is composed of registers, a binary adder and Circuitry, which compares
information and makes decisions based on the results of the comparisons.
In a computer, internal memory or primary memory refers to the storage locations inside the
computer, whereas secondary memory refers to the storage embodied in the peripherals. Primary
memory can be divided into three types: core, chip and bubble.
Secondary memory, on the other hand, may be grouped as sequential ( tape ) or random
access ( disk ).
The input devices can either be a card reader, a tape drive, a disk drive or a terminal.
These devices enter information into the computer. After the processor has operated on it, the
output devices display the results of the computations on either a printer or a terminal, or store
them on tape or disk for future use.
In today’s lesson you read about steps involved in ‘Problem Solving’. We followed the usual
pattern of reading followed by comprehension exercises, scanning for information, vocabulary
and content review exercises. This was followed by exploring the ‘Cause Effect Relationship’
between texts and working with language for ‘Classifying’ in English.
136
VU
Lesson -21
In this lesson, we will read about presenting information graphically through a flowchart. We
will do exercises based on flow charts and read about constructing flow charts.
Flowcharting: So far, we have dealt mainly with computers, but now it is imperative that we
find out how a program is written. In all activities involving computers, it is necessary that the
programmer is aware of what the machine is doing and what a program is supposed to do. As
previously mentioned flowcharting, one of the steps in programming, indicates the logical path
the computer will follow in executing a program; it is a drawing very much like a road map.
Flowcharting is not restricted to the preparation of programs in a particular language and should
be done for each major problem before the writing of the program is attempted.
If the finished program does not run as it should, the errors are more easily detected on the
flowchart than in the maze of words, characters, and numbers that make up the computer
program. In order to develop a flowchart successfully, a programmer should be aware of the
sequence of steps needed to obtain a correct solution to a problem.
There are two ways of making a flowchart: the freehand version and the neater, more readable
version. In the former version, the graphic outlines are simply jotted down as the steps of the
program are worked out. This is quite satisfactory if the flowchart is not intended to be kept as a
permanent record. However, if a permanent, neater and more readable flowchart is needed, the
latter method whereby a template, a sheet of plastic with all the flowcharting symbols cut into it,
is used.
The following symbols should be used for the purpose of uniformity. The first and last symbol is
. This is terminal symbol which indicates the beginning or the end of a program.
The word ‘START’ must be inserted inside the figure if it is the beginning of the program and
‘STOP’ if it is the end of the program.
The figure in the form of a parallelogram is used as an input/output symbol. It indicates that
something is either brought to or taken form the program. The rectangular symbol stands for
processing and indicates a place in the program where action is taken. In a program, to indicate
that a decision has to be made, the diamond shaped symbol is used. The decision is usually in the
form of a question that must be answered by either ‘yes’ or ‘no’. Finally, the arrows are used to
show that the flow or direction in which the different actions in the program are performed.
It should be noted that flowchart is not a program, but only a step in the preparation of a
program, and is used in determining how to step up and write the program. However, if the
problem is not understood, neither the flowchart nor the program can be done correctly. It is
possible for two programmers working separately to write programs to solve the same problem
and come up with flowcharts and programs that may be altogether different.
After a program has been worked out, it is usually written down and kept with a copy of the
flowchart along with detailed instructions for the use and interpretation of the program. This
Exercises
1. Main Idea
Which statement expresses the main idea of the text? Why did you eliminate the other choices?
1. Every programmer must know how to flowchart.
2. Program documentation specifies what the program is supposed to do.
3. Flowcharting is a basic step in programming.
1. A good flowchart takes into account the steps which are necessary to solve the
problem.
2. It is not possible to draw a flowchart without using a template.
3. There is only one possible flowchart for every problem.
4. Every programmer must learn flowcharting and realize its importance.
5. The method of flowcharting depends on the programming language being used.
6. Flowcharts show the logic one has to follow to solve problem.
7. Documenting a program is essential in explaining what the program is
supposed to do.
8. If the flowchart is correct, the program will certainly work.
9. Each symbol in flowcharting has a specific meaning.
10. Flowchart can show processes, but not decision.
Answer:
1. A good flowchart takes into account the steps which are necessary to solve the
problem. T
2. It is not possible to draw a flowchart without using a template. F
3. There is only one possible flowchart for every problem. F
4. Every programmer must learn flowcharting and realize its importance. T
5. The method of flowcharting depends on the programming language being used. F
6. Flowcharts show the logic one has to follow to solve problem. T
7. Documenting a program is essential in explaining what the program is
supposed to do. T
8. If the flowchart is correct, the program will certainly work. F
9. Each symbol in flowcharting has a specific meaning. T
138
VU
3. Locating Information
……….. 1.A programmer must document his program in order that others may be able to
understand it.
……….. 2. Flowcharting resembles a map.
……….. 3. Flowcharting shows the logical ability of a programmer.
……….. 4. There is more than one way of flowcharting.
……….. 5. A certain symbol is used to indicate if a question is to be answered ‘yes’ or ‘no’.
Answers:
…P5... 1.A programmer must document his program in order that others may be able to
understand it.
…P1... 2. Flowcharting resembles a map.
…P6... 3. Flowcharting shows the logical ability of a programmer.
…P2... 4. There is more than one way of flowcharting.
…P3... 5. A certain symbol is used to indicate if a question is to be answered ‘yes’ or ‘no’.
4. Contextual Reference
Look back at the text and find out what the words in bold typeface refer to.
Answer:
1. Does not run as it should (l.10)………program….
2. In the former version (l.16)…………freehand version….
3. This is quite satisfactory (l.18)……… graphic jotting down outlines ……….
4. The latter method (l.20)…….…neater readable version…
5. Flowcharting symbols cut into it (l.21)………………sheet of plastic used….
6. Which indicates the beginning (l.23)…………symbol…
7. It indicates that something (l.27)……………….figure….
8. That may be altogether (l.40)……………….flow chart and program…
9. The original one is missing (l.48)……………flowchart…
10. Which is a must in programming (l.53)……… logical analytical ability …
5. Understanding Words
Refer back to the text and find synonyms for the following words.
Now refer back to the text and find antonyms for the following words.
6. Unlimited (l.7) ……………………
7. Undiscovered (1.11)……………………
8. Temporary (l.19)…………………..
9. Inaccessible (l.45)…………………..
10. Illogical (l.53)…………………..
6. Word forms
First choose the appropriate form of the words to complete the sentence. Then check the
differences of meaning in your dictionary.
140
VU
In calculating an employee’s
salary, a computer must go
through a number of operations in
a logical manner.
………………..it must read the
number of hours worked and the rate of pay for each hour worked. ………………………….. it
must calculate the gross salary; ………………… multiply the hours work by the rate of pay for
each hour worked…………...doing these two operations it must find out whether the employee
has worked overtime or not.
8. Focus Review
Focus on: Cause and Effect
Read again ‘Flowcharting’ to complete the table below
Making predictions:
A prediction is a statement about a particular subject which is related to a prior condition being
fulfilled. It is a special kind of inference in which we tell in advance what we think will happen
in the future. It is therefore impossible to predict without having any knowledge of an existing
condition.
By examining existing data, a logical conclusion can often be logically drawn about what is
likely to happen next. Predictions of results based on existing conditions can be expressed as
different levels of certainty. They are not absolute and can change according to context. For
example,
1. Certainly (100%) can be expressed by:
142
VU
Could not
Not possible, impossible
When a necessary condition exists in process, the following expressions are used:
For Y to occur/happen/take place {x must be present or there must be Y, Y depends on X}
In a condition-prediction relationship, the statement of condition is preceded by ‘if’; no matter to
what degree of certainty the prediction is expressed.
Also the verb tenses are important to note because a distinction between the statements of
condition which is made in the present must relate to the events of the prediction which will
happen in the future.
Examples:
1. The rate at which computer technology is growing, today’s computers might be
obsolete by 2005 and most certainly by 2010.
CONDITION PREDICTION
CONDITION PREDICTION
3. If the hammer in drum printers hits a little early or late, the characters will appear slightly
above or below the line.
CONDITION PREDICTION
Exercise:
Read the following sentences and underline the part that expresses a condition, once; and the part
expressing a prediction, twice.
1. It has been said that if transport technology had developed as rapidly as computer technology,
a trip across the Atlantic Ocean today would take a few seconds.
2. Working for the U.S. Census Bureau, Dr. Hollerith realized that unless some means of
speeding up the analyses of census data were found, it would take more than ten years to
complete the job.
3. If the hammer in train printers hits a little early or late, the character will appear slightly to the
right of its proper position.
4. Mainframes would still be occupying a lot of space if it weren’t for microminiaturization.
5. If computer technology continues growing at the rate it has, bubble memory will soon replace
the chip.
In today’s lesson we read about flowcharting followed by comprehension exercises, scanning for
information vocabulary and content review exercises. We explored through exercises the
relationship between ‘Cause and Effect’. Finally, we looked at how to make predictions, what
language is to be used for making predictions.
With this we come to the end.
144
VU
Lesson -22
Until now the focus of our lessons has been on the development of your reading comprehension
skills but now the focus will shift to writing of sentences and paragraphs and grammar. In today’s
lesson we will look at different sentence types.
Sentence Types:
Despite the wide availability and use of computers, word processors and electronic
communication devices, most of us still communicate with one another by exchanging written
and spoken words. And we naturally want to express ourselves as well as possible. We want to be
able to communicate our thoughts to others accurately, convincingly, and of course, gracefully.
Thinking, speaking and writing are closely related to each other. If you are familiar with the
essential rules of good English and think clearly, you will speak and write with confidence - the
confidence that comes from a sense of having mastered the rules and conventions which must be
followed in all acceptable writing.
2You as a student interested in writing in English will have to learn and master these rules and
conventions if you are to communicate your thoughts successfully. These rules and standards are
important. Until you have grasped them well, you will be handicapped, for you will lack the
tools of the craft of writing.
Remember, writing does not come of itself. It is a skill, a learned skill. It’s a specialized skill
which needs a lot of practice. Writing in a foreign language is not easy, even native speakers
found it extremely difficult to express themselves, and for foreign learners of English like you
and me, it is all the more difficult. But with knowledge and practice one can learn to write well.
Good writing depends on knowledge of three things:
i) Rules of grammar-syntax
ii) Rhetoric and
iii)Composition.
Grammar: deals with the parts of speech, with the variations in the form of words when used in
different constructions, and with the relationship between different words within the sentence
(syntax). You will also discover that the rules of grammar are quite definite and at the same time
you will find that under certain circumstances, a form of a word is correct and other forms are
incorrect grammar. Grammar concerns all the rules of language use. It classifies words into all
sorts of categories and describes the peculiarities of each category. Grammar has many
categories and specifies each category by a term or name which enables us to recognize it. The
English language has 8 parts of speech – the different kinds of words used for different purposes
in a sentence. You are familiar with the 8 parts of English speech – Noun Verb Pronoun,
Adjective, Adverb, Proposition, Conjunction, and Interjection. In addition to the 8 parts of
speech there are other terms that you must become familiar with in order to understand and write
effective sentences. There are 4 kinds of words that are two parts of speech combined into one,
these are: participle, gerund, infinitive and relative adverb.
1. Participle:
It is a verb and adjective combined e.g. the retired headmaster distributed the prizes.
Gerund: is a verb and noun combined; e.g. She is thinking of leaving her job.
Infinitive: is also a verb and noun combined. e.g. She wishes to deposit the money.
Relative Adverb: is partly an adverb and partly a conjunction e.g. I was relieved when the
program ended. Besides knowledge of grammar, the other two things required for good writing
are Rhetoric which deals with the choice of words and their effective arrangement and
Composition, which is ‘putting together’ of parts to form a whole: words into sentences,
sentences into paragraphs and paragraphs into longer units. This arrangement is essential to all
writing.
The rules of rhetoric and composition, which are less rigid than the rules of grammar, provide the
standards of good writing. Remember these rules of good English are the result of generations of
experiments in the art of using words for communication.
Even messages composed on word processors, for instance, are texts constructed of words and
sentences according to the rules and usages of English grammar, spelling and punctuation.
Writing then is a means of communication as well as self-expression. In most cases, students are
capable of communicating their ideas, knowledge, experiences and opinions. But almost
everyone, no matter how accomplished in communicating with others can benefit from help or
advice in improving his/her communication skills.
Control over sentences means the ability to employ different kinds of sentence patterns or forms.
Our students are generally weak in sentence structure. In the coming weeks you shall have
practice in sentence construction. A sentence is a group of words containing a subject (Noun or
Noun equivalent) and a verb (action or state of being) in which something is expressed about
something else. The sentence is the equivalent in words of the complete thought from your mind,
and it is with sentences i.e. complete thoughts that we compose paragraphs from which we
construct essays, letters, reports, books, etc….
In order to write well you must be able to construct good, effective sentences. In today’s lesson
you will learn about types of sentences and have practice in all types of sentences. Sentences can
be classified according to the way they are constructed and according to their purpose / meaning.
We will first consider sentences according to their meaning / purpose.
To make a statement, assertion or declaration:
e.g. He is a teacher. It is cloudy.
b. To ask a question. e.g. What day is it?
c. To issue commands. e.g. Go in
d. To utter exclamations. e.g. If only it would stop raining!
e. To offer greetings and other expressions which have no definite forms: e.g. Good morning.
Hello. Shut-up.
146
VU
II Sentences may be also classified according to their structure, which is determined by the kind
and number of clauses / statements in them. Depending upon how it is constructed, sentences in
English are either simple, compound, complex or compound - complex. So we can say these are
the four most basic kinds of sentences in English. We need to distinguish these four kinds of
sentences from each other.
The Simple Sentence:
(a) Any sentence, however long or short, that has only one subject - verb combination and
expresses a complete thought is a simple sentence consisting of one subject and one verb.
a) - Sparks fly upwards. (3)
- The tired, dirty and footsore tourists, straggled wearily across the bridge, up the hill, and
finally into the rest house. (20)
The second sentence contains 20 words, but, because it has one subject (tourists) and one finite
verb (straggled), it is classified as a simple sentence.
b) A simple sentence may have more than one subject. e.g.
- Lamb and Hazlitt wrote charming essays.
-Towels and bed sheets sway on the clothesline.
Practice 1:
Complete the simple sentences by filling in one or more subjects and one or more verbs.
1. ___________ is my favourite sport.
2. The batsman __________ the ball.
3. The ___________ gave me the bill.
4. A suitcase _________ off the van and _________ into a ditch.
5. As it was raining the children __________ indoors and ___________ cartoons on TV.
The Compound Sentence is made up of two or more complete thoughts e.g.
- Saima wants biryani for dinner, but she forgot to buy meat.
-His life was not an easy one, nor was it eventful.
Joining Words The following table explains all the joining words.
and means in addition
but - however
so - as a result
for - because
yet - however
or is used to show alternatives
nor is used to show a second negative statement
3. A storm was approaching, quickly. The mountain climber found shelter in a cave.
4. Dad likes coffee for breakfast. Mom prefers tea.
A complex sentence on the other hand, includes one independent statement (clause) and at least
one dependent statement, which cannot stand alone, e.g.
- When the century began, there were many noun coffee houses in the city (adverbial).
- Men who wanted to meet their friends visited these shops (adjectival)
-We know that these gatherings led eventually to the formation of a new political party. (Noun).
The second statement in the sentence is independent. It can stand alone as a simple sentence:
there were many coffee houses in the city. The first statement, however, cannot stand alone. It is
dependent - it depends on the rest of the sentence to complete the thought.
There are several ways in which a dependent statement (clause) may be used in a sentence -
adverbial, adjectival, noun.
- When the century began, there were many coffee houses in the city (adverbial).
- Men who wanted to meet their friends visited these shops (adjectival).
-We know that these gatherings led eventually to the formation of a new political party. (Noun)
- When the century began, there were many coffee houses in the city (adverbial).
- Men who wanted to meet their friends visited these shops (adjectival).
-We know that these gatherings led eventually to the formation of a new political party.
(Noun).
Dependent statements also begin with dependent words, such as although. They also include a
subject and a verb. e. g. In the sentence:
Although many nearby trees were uprooted, our house escaped the storm, (the subject of the
dependent statement is trees, the verb is “were uprooted”).
148
VU
This is also a complex sentence: one part can stand independently as a simple sentence:
Police surrounded the building. The other part of the sentence has a subject and a verb, but it
begins with a dependent word and cannot stand alone: As the mad man made demands on the
phone.
Here’s another complex sentence. See if you can spot the independent and dependent parts of the
sentence
- Ghazala will not sell her old gramophone even if she is offered a large sum of money.
Ghazala will not sell her old gramophone even if she is offered a large sum of money.
DEPENDENT WORDS: In the example you have seen, the words although, as, and even if
introduce statements that are dependent. There are various other dependent words also known as
subordinating conjunctions. Look at the previous examples again to understand how to punctuate
complex sentences.
- As the mad man made demands on the phone, police surrounded the building.
-Ghazala will not sell her old gramophone even if she is offered a large sum of money.
Punctuate
- As the mad man made demands on the phone, police surrounded the building.
-Ghazala will not sell her old gramophone even if she is offered a large sum of money.
List of some dependent words
After even
If unless where
Although even
Though until wherever
As if when
Whether
Because since whenever
While
Before though
Practice 3
Complete the following statements then underline the dependent statement/clause. Remember
every dependent should have a subject and a verb.
1. Didi cried _______________________.
2. Although ____________________, I was too tired to go for a swim.
3. Because ___________________ I set my alarm for 4 a.m.
4. Asim did some research in the library ____________________________
Practice 4: Combine the first two sentences into one sentence, and combine the last two
sentences into another sentence. Use any of the following joining words and dependent words.
Joining Words: and, but, so
Dependent Words: after, although, because, when
150
VU
SENTENCE
Compound Complex sentences consist of a compound sentence (two or more independent
statements/clauses) and at least one dependent statement /clause. The following sentences are
samples of compound - complex sentences:
1. The Rawal Lake was impressive, but Shahid thought that Lake Saiful Malook was really more
beautiful than any other lake he had even seen.
2. The crowd of laborers had been standing patiently in the water for three hours, and great
shout of relief arose when the rescuers finally appeared.
Lesson Review:
1. In a compound sentence the statements / clauses are joined together by a
a. dependent word
b. comma and a joining word
c. semicolon
152
VU
Lesson -23
We looked at different kinds of sentences in the last lesson, simple, compound and complex. In
this lesson, we will focus on writing effective sentences by looking at issues like the unity of a
sentence and the emphasis in a sentence.
Effective Sentences
I. Unity: A good sentence should have unity, that is, it must express one main idea. Although a
sentence may contain more than one fact, all the facts must relate to the main idea. E.g. the
models were all dressed in the latest fashions and many of them are unemployed. This sentence
does not have unity. The first clause tells us about the model’s clothing, e.g. the models were all
dressed in the latest fashions and many of them are unemployed. While the second one mentions
unemployment; the two different ideas don’t belong to one another in one sentence. They should
be stated in two separate sentences. This sentence is a sample of a sentence that lacks unity.
Unity is violated in five ways:
(i) By combining unrelated ideas
(ii) Putting too many ideas / details in a single sentence.
(iii) Failure to complete an idea or grammatical construction
(iv) Subordination
(v) Parallelism
(i) Combining unrelated ideas e.g. The students at the college use a great deal of abusive
language and they are from all parts of the country.
(ii)Too many ideas or details put in a single sentence distract the reader from the main thought
of the sentence e.g. Reading his daily newspaper that morning, standing at the crowded bus stop,
the morning sun just lighting up the tops of the high buildings and making the sleepy-eyed people
shade their eyes, made a great impression on me.
EXAMPLES
i. The students at the college use a great deal of abusive language and they are from all parts of
the country.
ii.Reading his daily newspaper that morning, standing at the crowded bus stop, the morning
sun just lighting up the tops of the high buildings and making the sleepy-eyed people shade their
eyes, made a great impression on me.
(iii) Failure to complete an idea or a grammatical construction: Such sentences are the result
of carelessness on the part of the writer who thinks that the reader will not object to filling in the
gaps in the thought e.g. -
This is such a heavy chair.
I was so pleased about the letter.
The news is too wonderful.
All these expressions can be improved by adding a clause or substituting another word for such,
so and too. e.g.
When you place the principal or main thought in a subordinate position unity of the sentence is
destroyed.
(Faulty) The fielder in the slips dropped the third catch, when the match was definitely lost.
(Improved) When the fielder in the slips dropped the third catch the match was definitely lost.
The fielder in the slips dropped the third catch, when the match was definitely lost (Faulty)
Practice 1:
The following sentences can be improved by using the correct connectives and making the
subordinate thoughts give emphasis to the main thought.
1. I was reaching down to pick up my cap just as I saw the two snakes.
154
VU
2. We came within sight of the village when our car suddenly caught fire.
3. Because he has been to college is no sign he is cultured.
4. The main reason I left early was because I was bored.
5. Mr. Jamshed is the Vice President while the Saeed is the Secretary.
Practice 2:
The following sentences are lacking in unity. Improve them by adding details & changing words
where necessary.
1. The librarian was so discouraged about the lack of funds.
2. Our situation is too wonderful
3. Trying to work when my neighbour is playing his drum is such a problem.
4. The young ladies wore bright coloured socks and were kind hearted
5. She is so talented.
6. Computer courses have more appeal for the college student today.
We have seen that less important ideas must be made subordinate to the main idea of a sentence.
However, if two ideas are co-ordinate, they must be given equal rank in the sentence. This is
known as parallelism. Students very often use faulty parallelism. Great care must be used in the
matter of parallel structure. Nouns must be parallel to nouns, verbs to verbs, subordinate clauses
to subordinate clauses gerunds to gerunds, etc…..
(a) She told me to look on the table and that I should tell her what I found.
(b) Seema’s job is reading books and to write book reviews.
(c) He was considerate, friendly, and people respected him.
(d) The couple want to travel extensively and new experiences.
(e) The professor drew attention to the beginning of the revolution and how it ended.
(f) Getting the groceries, taking the children to school and to feed the dog are his daily tasks.
NOTE 1: e.g. For lunch I had an apple pie and banana.
NOTE :(1) It is often necessary to repeat preposition or other words in order to make
parallelism clear. e.g. For lunch I had an apple pie and banana.
(Improved) For lunch I had an apple pie and a banana.
(2) Correlatives (either…or / not only…also) should be used only with parallel elements.
He not only likes tennis but also golf.
(Improved)
He not only likes tennis but also golf.
You must bear in mind that faulty parallelism is worse than no parallelism at all. You should use
parallelism freely in your sentences but should resist all temptation to force into parallel structure
clauses which are not parallel in thought.
Practice 3:
II. So far we have looked at how the unity of sentences is destroyed. Now we shall turn to the
second element, coherence, which helps to create an effective sentence. A sentence has
coherence when the various parts follow one another in an order which makes their relationship
clear.
Correct handling of matters of unity, parallelism and subordination contributes to coherence.
When working for coherence there are 4 pitfalls which must be avoided at all costs. These are
weak, general or ambiguous reference of pronouns, split constructions, use of mixed
constructions and mixed figures of speech and needless shifting from one point of view to
another – all these destroy coherence in a sentence.
(i) Ahmed saw Basit and Zahid yesterday and he said that he had the money. (ambig)
(ii) My aunt’s cat was crippled; and she was never the same again. (Ambiguous aunt, cat?)
(iii) She put the computer on the table, which her sister had bought.
Note: Don’t treat an antecedent first as singular and then as plural. e.g.
(i) The Guard Company is now using coal in their furnaces instead of fuel oil.
(ii) The club has done their best to raise the money.
2. Split Constructions: e.g.
For Example
(i) He ran to the station and the train was taken by him. (Active to passive)
156
VU
(ii) If one tries hard, they can accomplish much. (Singular to plural)
(iii) The only words that we were able to distinguish are ‘horse’ and ‘cart’.
(Past to present)
Practice 4:
III. Emphasis.
Practice 5:
Lesson -24
In earlier lessons we have been exploring ways of writing more effective sentences. In this
lesson, we will look at the errors we all make and how to revise these errors.
Having considered the general elements which make for effectiveness in sentences, we will now
take up four common errors in sentence construction. These errors should be avoided by all who
write in English. These errors are:
i Sentence Fragments
ii Run-on sentences
(a) Fused sentences (b) comma splice
iii Misplaced and Dangling Modifiers
Sentence Fragments
We said that a sentence is a group of words that must contain a subject and a verb. It must also
express one complete thought. Therefore a number of ideas must not be huddled together in a
simple unit. Now a sentence fragment, as the phrase tells you, is less than a sentence - it is a
fragment because it lacks a subject or a verb or because it does not express a complete thought.
The following are samples of fragments.
Some fragments contain a subject and a verb, but they do not express a complete thought e.g.
- Since Ami was tired.
- When the postman arrived.
- After I had switched off the light.
- Since Ami was tired, she took a nap.
There was loud knocking on the front door after I had switched off the light
158
VU
Practice1
Practice 2:
This practice will give you a sense of the difference between a dependent-word fragment and a
complete sentence. Turn each fragment into a sentence by adding a statement that completes the
thought.
1. When I rang the doorbell, ______________.
2. Since I had forgotten my house keys, ______________.
3. As I walked into the classroom, __________________.
4. Unless her temperature goes down soon, ____________.
5. Schools were closed yesterday, __________.
1. When I rang the doorbell, the lights of the house went out.
2. Since I had forgotten my house keys, I had to break the door.
3. As I walked into the classroom, the fire alarm rang.
4. Unless her temperature goes down soon, we will have to consult a specialist.
5. Schools were closed yesterday because of the political rally.
(a) When a word ending in -ing appears at the beginning of a group of words a fragment may
result. e.g.
- Hoping to buy things cheaply. Poor people often go the Sunday bazaars.Here the second
statement is a complete sentence. But the first group of words lacks both a subject and a verb, so
it is a fragment.
(b) Here is an example of a ‘to’ fragment.
- The ladies jogged through the park. To lose weight.
There are two ways to correct -ing and to fragments.
a) Connect the fragment to the sentence it explains. e.g. - Hoping to buy things cheaply, poor
people often go to the Sunday bazaar. Remember to put a comma after an-ing or a to word group
that starts a sentence.
b) Create a complete sentence by adding a subject and a verb to the fragment and revise the
material as necessary. e.g. -Poor people often to the Sunday bazaar. They hope to buy things
cheaply.- The ladies jogged through the park. They wanted to lose weight.
Hoping to buy things cheaply, poor people often go to the Sunday bazaar.
-Poor people often to the Sunday bazaar. They hope to buy things cheaply.
- The ladies jogged through the park. They wanted to lose weight
Practice 3:
First identify the -ing or to fragment in each of the following items. Then rewrite the correct
version using one of the two methods just discussed.
1- Police officers stood all over the road. Directing traffic around the accident.
2. Rising high into the sky. The huge yellow kite could be seen for miles.
3. Sarah painted a landscape. To enter the contest
4. To get off the diving board. The swimmer did a somersault.
1- Police officers stood all over the road. Directing traffic around the accident.
- Police officers stood all over the road, directing traffic around the accident.
2. Rising high into the sky. The huge yellow kite could be seen for miles.
- Rising high into the sky, the huge yellow kite could be seen for miles.
3. Sarah painted a landscape. To enter the contest.
- Sarah painted a landscape. She wanted to enter the contest.
4. To get off the diving board. The swimmer did a somersault.
-The swimmer wanted to get off the diving board. He did a somersault.
Another common kind of fragment begins with one of the following words: like, including, such
as, for example, for instance, except, without, especially, and also. All these words introduce an
additional point or example to what has already been stated. e.g.
- Everyone enjoyed the feast. Except the fish.
- We had to read several novels. Including ‘The Ice Age’.
In each of these examples, the second word group lacks both a subject and a verb.
Note that each of these fragments begins with an Added Detail word or phrase:
except and including. To correct an Added Detail fragment you follow the same
two methods as used for the last type of fragment -ing and to fragments.
A. Add the fragment to the sentence it explains.
B. Create a new sentence by adding a subject and verb to the fragment and revise the
material as necessary.
Practice 4
Identify the added - detail fragment in each of the following items then write the correct version
using one of the two methods given earlier.
1. The former playmates walked passed one another. Without saying a word.
160
VU
2. For a main dish, I often serve meat and vegetables. For example, fish and spinach.
3. The policeman searched the room for clues. Such as old photographs, old letters and old
receipts.
4. Oranges are full of nutrients. Especially vitamin C.
1-The former playmates walked past one another without saying a word.
2-For a main dish, I often serve meat and vegetables. For example, I mix fish with spinach.
3- The policeman searched the room for clues such as old photographs, old letters and old
receipts.
4- Oranges are full of nutrients especially vitamin C.
Some word groups are fragments because, while they do have a verb, they lack a subject. e.g.
-The poor woman paid all her utility bills. But then had little money left over for food.
- The nurse held a smiling baby. Then posed for the photographers.
In each of the above examples the first statement is a complete sentence and second word group
is a fragment.
Note that in each fragment the subject is missing. The first fragments omits the subject of the
verb had and the second fragment omits the subject of the verb posed.
To correct a missing-subject fragment you again follow the same two methods that you used for
the correction of the earlier types of fragments.
(a) Connect the missing-subject fragment to the sentence that comes before it. Add a joining
word if needed for a smooth connection as given in the examples that follow.
(a) - The poor woman paid all her utility bills but had little money left for her food..
-The nurse held a smiling baby and then posed for the photographers.
(b) Create new sentence by adding a subject to the fragment. Normally you will add a pronoun
that stands for the subject of the previous sentence.
(b) - The poor woman paid all her utility bills. But she had little money left for her food..
- The nurse held a smiling baby. Then she posed for the photographers.
Practice 5:
Identify the missing subject-fragment in each of the following items. Then write the correct
version using one of the two methods you have learned.
1. The sleeping dog opened one eye to look at the postman. And then went back to sleep.
The sleeping dog opened one eye to look at the postman and then it went back to sleep.
2. Each morning, my secretary checks the answering machine for messages. Then opens the mail.
-Each morning, my secretary checks the answering machine for messages. Then she opens the
mail.
3. Maryam skipped her afternoon classes. And worked on a paper due the next morning.
Maryam skipped her afternoon. Classes and she worked on a paper due the next morning.
4. The movie had melodious music and popular actors. Yet made little money at the box office.
Melodious and popular Yet it made little money at the box of
The movie had melodious and popular actors. Yet it made little money at the box office.
Lesson Review
Answer each question by filling in the correct word/words in the blank space.
1. To be sentence, a group of words must contain a subject and a ___________and it must
express_______________________.
2. Words such as because, until and while are known as _____words because word groups that
begin with them depend on another statement to complete the thought.
3. Fragments that begin with words such as like, especially, and for example are known as
_________fragments.
4. One way to correct an added-detail fragment is to create a new _______ by adding a subject
and _________to the fragment.
5. One way to correct a missing-subject fragment is to add a _______ to the fragment.
TEST:
Sentence Fragments
Rewrite the following. Correct any fragments.
1. We go to Murree Hills during the summer vacations. Whenever we can, of course.
2. Our literary circle has only two officers. Miss Niazi being president and Mr. Awan being
secretary treasure.
3. Living in the city is not always pleasant. During the summer months particularly.
4. He hated learning foreign languages. Latin, French and German especially.
5. Moving up the mountain at a fast pace. The soldiers were soon exhausted. They were not used
to climbing at high altitudes. Where the air was thinner.
6. When people are scared. The hair on their bodies really can “stand on end”. Each hair is
attached to a tiny muscle. This can pull the hair straight up. The muscles react together in
response to a great fright.
The word groups beginning with when & which are dependent – word fragment, so each needs
to be added to the sentence that comes before or after it. When people are scared, the hair on
their bodies really can “stand on end”. Each hair is attached to a tiny muscle which can pull the
hair straight up. The muscles react together in response to a great fright.
162
VU
Lesson -25
In earlier lessons we have been exploring ways of writing more effective sentences. In the last
lesson we did sentence errors and in today’s lesson we will continue to look at sentence errors
and how to revise these errors.
In the last lesson we looked at the most common type of sentence error - the sentence fragment.
Today we shall examine the next two most common types of sentence errors, which are the run-
on sentences and dangling modifiers. First we will look at run on sentences.
A run-on sentence is a sentence that is made up of two complete thoughts that have no clear
break between them.
There are two kinds of run-on sentences:
(i) Fused sentences
ii) Comma splice sentences.
Two or more sentences that run together with no marks of punctuation between them are said to
be fused. The two sentences or two complete statements / thoughts are simply stuck together into
one sentence. The writer of such a sentence is either extremely careless or is ignorant of the most
elementary facts about sentence structure. E.g.
(a) Computer skills are useful in college. They will help you in getting a job as well.
(b) Our club raised money for the Red Crescent an organization like this is a wonderful thing.
(c) He left early he said he had a toothache.
A good way to prevent fused sentences is to read aloud what you have written. Also look within
the sentence for words like I, you, he, she, it, we, they, there, this, that, now, then and next. Such
words often signal the beginning of a complete thought.
Examples
(a) Computer skills are useful in college. They will help you in getting a job as well.
(b) Our club raised money for the Red Crescent an organization like this is a wonderful thing.
(c) He left early he said he had a toothache.
Practice1.
Identify the following sentences as fused (F) or comma splice (CS). Then mark the place
between the two complete thoughts with a slash (/). The first two have been done for you.
E.g. (a) The room is locked / no one has a key. F
(b) The wall is covered with ivy, / a stone path leads to the wall. CS
1. Raheel likes to cook his wife taught him how. ( _________ ).
2. The bell rang the wrestlers returned to the ring. ( ____ )
The comma always goes before the joining word - not after it.
3. Use subordination to make one of the complete thoughts dependent on the other one. To
subordinate a complete thought, change it from a statement that can stand alone as a sentence to
one that cannot stand by itself.
To do so, begin the thought with an appropriate word, such as because, when, if, before, since,
until, unless, while, as, though and after.
Example
- Youhanna has a pulled muscle he won’t do any batting in this tournament.
-Because Youhanna has a pulled muscle, he won’t do any batting in this tournament.
Note:
Practice 2: Correct each of the fused sentences that follow using one of the methods described
earlier. Use a different method for each sentence.
1. It wasn’t his idea he should have known better than to do it.
It wasn’t his idea. He should have known better than to do it.
2. It’s easy to begin smoking it’s much harder to quit.
It’s easy to begin smoking, but it’s much harder to quit.
3. Some workers at the factory have been laid off the others are nervous.
Because some workers at the factory have been laid off, the others are nervous.
164
VU
4. The room looked wonderful the carpets had just been vacuumed.
The room looked wonderful. The carpets had just been vacuumed.
5. The fish was served with its head still on, I lost my appetite.
Because the fish was served with its head still on, I lost my appetite.
6. First you should clean the floor, and then you should vacuum the carpet.
First you should clean the floor, and then you should vacuum the carpet.
A comma splice can be connected by using one of the same three methods suggested for
correcting a fused sentence:
1. Divide the comma splice into two sentences:
-Saad is always nervous about tests. His grades are usually the best in the class.
2. Connect the two complete thoughts by placing a joining word (such as and, but or so) after the
comma:
-Saad is always nervous about tests, but his grades are usually the best in the class.
3. Use subordination (add a dependent word to one of the complete thoughts):
-Saad is always nervous about tests although his grades are usually the best in the class.
Practice 3:
Correct each of the comma splices that follow, using one of the methods suggested. Use a
different method for each sentence.
1. Fahd was talking on the phone; he was switching TV channels with his remote control at the
same time.
-Fahd was talking on the phone, and he was switching TV channels with his remote control at
the same time.
2. Mules are very sure-footed; they’re used for climbing steep mountains.
-Mules are very sure-footed, so they’re used for climbing steep mountains.
3. The electricity at the shopping center went out; all the shops had to close early.
-Since the electricity at the shopping center went out, all the shops had to close early.
4. Bicycles are the world’s best method of transportation, they don’t pollute the atmosphere.
- Bicycles are the world’s best method of transportation, because they don’t pollute the
atmosphere.
5. I don’t like the Principal’s way of expressing herself, I agree with many of her ideas.
- Although I don’t like the Principal’s way of expressing herself, I agree with many of her ideas.
4. Two complete thoughts can be joined together in a sentence by a comma and a ________ word
such as and, but or so.
5. Two complete thoughts can be joined together in one sentence by adding a _______ word such
as when or because.
6. The fused sentence and the comma splice are also known as _____ sentences.
Answers:
1. Run-on
2. Comma splice
3. Full stop / period
4. Joining
5. Dependent
6. Run-on
Test:
Misplaced modifier is a modifier that is incorrectly separated from the word or words that it
describes. The misplaced modifier seems to describe words that the writer did not intend it to
describe. When modifiers are misplaced, the reader may misunderstand the sentence.
-My brother bought a used car from a local dealer with a leaking pipe.
-The sparrow built a nest at the back of our house of grass and twigs.
-Anjum Nisar almost sneezed twenty times last night.
-
-My brother bought a used car (with a leaking pipe) from a local dealer.
-The sparrow built a nest (of grass and twigs) at the back of our house.
- Anjum Nisar sneezed (almost) twenty times last night.
166
VU
PRATICE 1:
Identify the misplaced word(s) in each sentence. Then rewrite the sentence placing the modifier
where it will make the meaning clear.
1. I am returning the jacket to the store that is too small.
2. The couple looked at thirty sofas shopping on Saturday.
3. The woman tore open the parcel she had just received with her finger nails.
4. The bracelet on Ayesha’s arm made of silver belongs to her mother.
5. Take this jar to uncle Aman’s home which he lent to me.
NOTE:
Pay special attention to single word modifiers, such as only, almost and nearly. For their
meaning to be correctly understood, they should be placed directly in front of the word they
describe.
e.g. (i) I only asked my boss for one day’s leave, but he refused.
(ii) I must have almost answered a hundred ads before I found this job
(iii) After returning from college my niece nearly spends all evening on the telephone.
Dangling Modifiers
Staring dreamily into space, the instructor’s loud voice startled me.
-Staring dreamily into space, I was started by the instructor’s loud voice. OR
-As I was staring dreamily into space, the instructor’s loud voice startled me.
Here are more samples of ways by which dangling modifiers can be corrected.
-When pulling out of the driveway, the pillar blocks my view.
-When pulling out of the drive way, I find my view blocked by the pillar.
OR
– Whenever I pull out of the driveway, the pillar blocks by view.
PRACTICE 2
In each sentence identify the misplaced or dangling modifier. Then rewrite each sentence so that
its intended meaning is clear.
1. The man returned the overdue book to the librarian with apologies.
2. The soldiers hold up in the caves almost went without food and water for a week.
3. The sky was blue and clear when we arrived home. But only a short while later, with a sudden
crash of thunder, we hurried to close the windows in the bedrooms. Staring out at the downpour,
we were glad to be safe inside. Then we remembered our open car windows, groaning with
dismay.
4. I lost my raincoat last winter. I thought I’d looked everywhere for it. Then, yesterday, stuffed
under the bed, I spotted it. Wrinkled and dusty, I was still delighted to see it.
In today’s lesson you looked at some more sentence errors – the fragment, fused and comma
splices and dangling modifiers. All good writers avoid these errors, and you should also try to
avoid making such errors.
168
VU
Lesson -26
In a correctly written sentence, the subject and verb agree i.e. match in number. In other words a
singular subject will take a singular verb and plural subjects will take plural verbs. Most students
have no problem handling a simple sentence where its not difficult to make the subject and verb
agree or match. e.g.
- My mother works at two jobs. My grandma takes care of my brothers and sisters.
Not all sentences are so straight forward.
In today’s lesson you shall learn about situations that can cause problems with subject - verb
agreement.
Before we look at the situations that can cause problems a little revision of the tenses is
necessary to brush up your knowledge. e.g.- Last night, I played chess. My friends played cards.
Now this sentence you must have noticed is in same for all subjects, whether singular or plural.
However, present tense verbs have two forms. Look at the following table. Notice the pattern of
present tense verbs.
Singular Plural
I work You work
You work We work
He works They work
She works
It works
Did you notice that:
(i) There is an S at the end of present tense verbs for singular subjects except for I and you.
(ii) There is no S at the end of present tense verbs for I, you and all plural verbs.
Having revised the present tense verbs we will now look at the situations which can pose
problems in subject-verb agreement.
In many sentences the subject is close to the verb, without the subject coming first.
The 1st type of problem situation occurs when the subject and verb do not occur side by side.
e.g.
Most shops on Mall Road are having sales this week.
In the above sentence, a prepositional phrase on Mall Road, separates the subject shops and the
verb are having. A prepositional phrase is a group of words that begins with a preposition (such
as, in, on, for, from, of, to) and ends with a noun or pronoun.
S V V
Most shops on Mall Road, are having sales this week.
Remember the subject of the sentence is never part of a prepositional phrase.
Let us have short practice of finding the subject of a sentence with a prepositional phrase.
Practice2.
In the following sentences first identify the prepositional phrase, and then pick out the subject of
each sentence. Finally spot the verb that agrees with the subject.
1. One of my best friends now lives / live in Dubai.
2. The wafer in this ice cream taste / tastes like sawdust.
3. Many people in the Indo-Pak subcontinent speaks / speak several languages.
4. No person in my class sleep / sleeps through my lecture.
5. The toddler by the swings is / are my nephew.
Answer:
S PP V
1. One (of my best friends) now lives (in Dubai)
S pp v
2. The wafer (in this ice cream) tastes like sawdust.
S pp v v
3. Many people (in the Indo-Pak subcontinent) speak several languages.
S pp v
4. No person (in my class) sleeps though my lecture.
S pp v
5. The toddler (by the swings) is my nephew.
In most English sentences, the verb usually follows the subject e.g.
I (saw) the film.
The plate (dropped) from her hands.
A plane (crashed)
But in some sentences the verb comes before the subject. Such sentences often are questions, or
they may begin with prepositional phrases or word groups like There is and Here are.
I (saw) the film.
170
VU
Even in such cases where the verb comes before the subject, the verb must agree with the
subject. e.g.
If you are not sure of the subject in a sentence, find the verb and then ask “who?” Or “what”.
In the second sentence for e.g. you would ask, ‘what are there in the district?” The answer,
“unemployed teachers”, is the subject.
For the third sentence, the question would be, ‘what is here?’ the answer, ‘The computer disk’ is
the subject.
Practice3.
The third situation that can pose problems in subject-verb agreement is when there is an
indefinite pronoun subject. Indefinite pronouns are pronouns that do not refer to a specific
person or thing.
Note the subject-verb relationships in the following sentences with indefinite pronouns subject.
e.g.
i. One of those correspondence courses is still open. (Sing sub one; sing v is)
ii. Neither of my parents is alive.
(Sing sub neither; sing v. is)
iii. Somebody was opening my letters
(Sing. Sub somebody; sing. v was)
iv. Nearby everyone in my class owns a computer. (Sing sub. Everyone; sing v owns).
Note the subject-verb relationships in the following sentences with indefinite pronouns subject.
e.g.
i. One of those correspondence courses is still open.
ii. Neither of my parents is alive.
iii. Somebody was opening my letters
iv. Nearby everyone in my class owns a computer.
Practice4.
Identify the subject and the verb that agrees with it.
i. ‘Everything in this crate goes / go upstairs’, she said.
ii. Neither of the phones works / work.
iii. No one favors / favor a cheat.
iv. Each of the appear / appears to have been nibbled by the same person.
v. Something about her story sound / sounds suspicious.
Compound Subjects
The fourth and the last type of situation which can pose problems in subject-verb agreement are
compound subjects.
1- Compound Subjects
Usually two or more subjects which are joined by and, they require a plural verb. e.g.
i. Petrol and car repairs are my biggest expenses every month.
ii. There were VCRs and Cameras for rent.
iii. Crockery and cutlery items are included in the bill.
2- When compound subjects are joined by or, nor, either…or, neither…nor, not only… but also,
the verb agrees with the closer subject. e.g.
-Either grapes or mango ice cream is the specialty every Saturday at the students dining hall.
-Either mango ice cream or grapes are the specialty every Saturday at the students dining hall.
3- While most indefinite pronouns such as each, everyone, one somebody etc. are always
singular, there are a few pronouns that are not. The pronouns both and a few are always plural
and require plural verbs.
e.g. - Both of my aunts play the sitar and sing professionally. A few of my cousins are also actors
172
VU
4. The pronouns all and some are either singular or plural depending on the words that follow
hem. If the words after them are singular, then they are singular. If the words after plural, then
they are plural e.g.
-Some of the chicken is still on the table.
(Since chicken is singular, some is singular in this sentence a singular verb, is needed).
-Some of the guests are not having chicken.
(Since guests are plural, it makes some plural in this sentence. The plural verb ‘are’ is
appropriate over here).
Practice 5
Identify the verb given in brackets that agrees with the compound subjects.
i Our aunts and uncles (stay / stays) with us when they come to Lahore.
ii. (Is / are) the actor and actresses ready to take the curtain call?
iii. Ropes and a clamp (holds / hold) the mural.
iv. The broken head lights and side light (was / were) the result of my bad driving.
v. The batsmen and the wicket keeper (require / requires) a fitness certificate.
vi. All of the students at the lecture (was / were) glad when it was over.
vii. Either Jameela or her daughter (stay / stays) at home to take care of Iqbal.
viii. Neither the head clerk nor his assistant clerks (has been / have been) fired for corruption.
ix. Not only Khalid but also his friends (is / are ) to blame for the accident.
x. A few of the strawberries (tastes / taste) funny.
Test
Each of the following passages contains two mistakes in subject-verb agreement. Find these
mistakes and correct them.
i. The rain forests of Brazil is home to many species of frogs. Nobody among the world’s
scientists know exactly how many. More types are being discovered all the time.
ii. The paint on the house and garage are peeling. Also each of the buildings need repairs.
However, there is never enough time to do those jobs.
iii. One of our professors always listens to students and makes sure they understand the lecture.
Each of his students feel free to ask questions. Also the tests in his classes are always fair and
clear.
Review:
RECAP:
In this lesson, you looked at subject -verb agreement within sentences and how an awareness of
correctness can improve your written expression. All good writers keep in mind these aspects of
language and avoid these subject verb discrepancies, and you should also try to avoid making
such errors.
174
VU
Lesson -27
Writing
In earlier lessons we have been exploring ways of writing more effective sentences. In today’s
lesson we will look at pronouns, their agreement reference and pint of view which are essential
for good writing.
e.g.
Practice 1 (A)
For each sentence write the pronoun needed and the word that the pronoun refers to. The first
sentence is done for you.
1. Neither of the babies has had (his, their) polio shot yet. (The pronoun needed is his. The word
it refers to is neither).
2. Many high schools now require (their, its) students to take a computer course.
3. Each of the girls invited (her, their) mother to the party.
4. Nobody can join the club unless (they are, he / she is) invited.
5. Everything in the office has (its, their) own place.
Practice 1 (A)
For each sentence write the pronoun needed and the word that the pronoun refers to. The first
sentence is done for you.
1. Neither of the babies has had (his, their) polio shot yet. (The pronoun needed is his. The word
it refers to is neither).
2. Many high schools now require (their, its) students to take a computer course. (The pronoun
needed is their. The word it refers to is schools).
3. Each of the girls invited (her, their) mother to the party. (The pronoun needed is her. The word
it refers to is each).
4. Nobody can join the club unless (they are, he / she is) invited. (The pronoun/s and verb needed
are he / she. The word the pronoun(s) and verb needed are he or she. The word the pronoun(s)
refer to is nobody).
5. Everything in the office has (its, their) own place. The pronoun needed is its. It refers to
everything.
Practice 1 (B)
Choose the correct pronoun(s) from the words given in brackets.
6. Each of the actresses who auditioned believes (she, they) should be chosen for the main role.
7. If anybody is interested in a part-time job at the library, (he / she, they) should let the chief
librarian known.
8. Either medicine is fine, but (it, they) must be taken regularly.
9. Somebody in the ladies’ lounge stole my dark glasses, and I would love to get back at (her,
them)
10. Neither of my uncles has ever smoked in (his, their) life.
Answer:
Practice 1(B): Choose the correct pronoun(s) from the words given in brackets.
6. Each of the actresses who auditioned believes (she, they) should be chosen for the main role.
7. If anybody is interested in a part-time job at the library, (he / she, they) should let the chief
librarian known.
8. Either medicine is fine, but (it, they) must be taken regularly.
176
VU
9. Somebody in the ladies’ lounge stole my dark glasses, and I would love to get back at (her,
them)
10. Neither of my uncles has ever smoked in (his, their) life.
(i) Rabia told Nafeesa that she had got an A in her term paper.
(ii) Javeria told Laila she will be unable to keep her job.
(iii) Personnel and management have reached tentative agreement on its contract.
(iv) Each student is encouraged to submit their work on time.
(v) There was no question after the lecture, which was regrettable.
(vi) Both of Basits’s parents are doctors, but it doesn’t interest Basit.
(i) Rabia told Nafeesa that she had got an A in her term paper. (who got the A - Rabia or
Nafeesa? The word she and her could refer to either one).
(ii) Javeria told Laila she will be unable to keep her job.
(iii) Personnel and management have reached tentative agreement on its contract.
4. Each student is encouraged to submit their work on time.
(v) There was no question after the lecture, which was regrettable. (What was regrettable -
lecture lack of questions? Be careful with the use of the pronouns ‘which’ and ‘this’. They must
clearly, refer to one things or situation.
(vi)Both of Basits’s parents are doctors, but it doesn’t interest Basit. (What doesn’t interest Basit?
Pronoun it doesn’t refer to anything in the sentence.)
Notice how communication is enhanced in these sentences given earlier. For the first
example you can write
Practice 2
Choose the correct word / words from those given in the brackets.
1. As Riaz told his father about being arrested, (Riaz, he) began to cry.
2. Students complain that (they, the maintenance staff) don’t keep the library tidy.
3. Mahnoor tore off the wrapping paper from the present and then threw (it, the paper) in the
rubbish bin.
4. Many poor people shop at the Sunday bazaar because (they, the vendors) give a 05 percent
discount.
5. Many people enjoy hiking and camping, but I’m not interested in (them, those activities).
Pronouns that refer to the person who is speaking is called a first person e.g. I, me, our. A
pronoun that refers to someone being spoken to, such as you, is a second person pronoun. And a
pronoun that refers to another person or thing, such as he, she, it, is third person pronoun. Here
are the personal pronouns in first, second and third person groupings. (See on red slide only)
When you write your pronoun, point of view must stay the same. Do not shift unnecessarily from
one point of view to another, as in the following sentences.
Personal Pronouns
(i) The worst thing about my not writing letters is that you never get any back. (The writer begins
with the first person pronoun my, but then shifts to the second person pronoun you).
(ii) Though we like most of our neighbors, there are a few you can’t get along with. (The writer
begins with the fist person pronouns we and our, but then shifts to the second person pronoun
you).
Practice 3
Answer:
1. What I like best about holidays is that you don’t have to set an alarm.
178
VU
- What I like best about holidays is that I don’t have to set an alarm.
2. The laborers have to take a break at 11:00 whether we want to or not.
- The laborers have to take a break at 11:00 whether they want to or not.
3. Whenever students are under a great deal of stress, we often go into depression
-Whenever students are under a great deal of stress, they often go into depression.
4. If you plan t do well on this course, one should plan on attending every lesson.
- If you plan to do well on this course, you should plan on attending every lesson.
5. When I first began to work as a nurse, I was surprised at how rude some patients were to you.
- When I first began to work as a nurse, I was surprised at how rude some patients were to me.
TEST A:
TEST – (A) Rewrite the following sentences after correcting the pronoun mistakes.
1. Neither friend wants to work in (his/their) family business. (Neither an indefinite pronoun is
singular. The second pronoun must agree with it in number).
2. If anyone does not want (his or her / their) pudding, I‘ll eat it.
3. When I was stopped for speeding, he said I’d been going beyond the speed limit.
- When I was stopped for speeding, the police officer said……
4. I won’t go to Abrar ul Haq’s concert tonight because there’s no way you could get a ticket.
- I won’t go to ……. No way could I get a ticket.
TEST B:
Each of the following passages contains two pronoun mistakes. Find the mistakes and rewrite the
correct version of the passage.
1. Bashir told Yousaf that he needed a new car. Bashir went on to say, “I still like my old Suzuki,
but the car spends more time in the workshop than on the road.” Yousaf agreed that anybody
who had to pay for so many repairs to their car should buy a new one.
(Bashir told Yousaf, “I need a new car”. Yousaf….. Yousaf agreed ……. So many repairs to his
car should buy a new one.
2. The restaurant down the road isn’t making a profit these days. During an inspection last
month, they found rats and cockroaches in the kitchen. The bad publicity caused the restaurant to
close down for a week, which was damaging to the restaurants business.
-The restaurant down the road …….. The health officials found …….. Close down for a week.
This closing was damaging
-The restaurant down the road …….. The health officials found …….. Close down for a week.
This closing was damaging
3. Each of the sisters is a successful artist in their own field. Amina does oil paintings that she
sells at the Grow Eaters’ Gallery. Kamilia makes jewelry which one sells by herself from her
home.
Each of the sisters is a successful artist in her own field……. Which she sells by herself from
her home.
4. An angry looking man stood outside the bank, shouting that they had stolen his money.
Passersby walked around him quickly because you did not know what he might do.
- (They have nothing in the sentence to refer to). Shouting that the bank employees had stolen
his money….quickly because they (passers by) did not know…….
TEST C:
In the following passage each sentence contains one pronoun mistake. Find the mistakes &
correct it.
1.
When Aunty Mussarrat and Uncle Riaz arrived, we all jumped up from the dinner table and
2.
rushed to the door, shouting their greetings. “I’m sorry we’re late,” said uncle Riaz, “but
3.
Mussarrat insists on driving at forty miles an hour, no matter how late you are.” “But you were
late in coming home from work and also in leaving Islamabad, and it’s all yours fault”, Aunty
4.
Mussarat answered. “The worst thing for me is living with such a fussy man you always have
to wait for him to finish selecting his wardrobe, washing his car and combing his hair just right,”
continued Aunty.
TEST C
Answer: In the following passage each sentence contains one pronoun mistake. Find the
mistakes & correct it.
1. When Aunty Mussarrat and Uncle Riaz arrived, we all jumped up from the dinner table and
rushed to the door, shouting their greetings. 2. “I’m sorry we’re late,” said uncle Riaz, “but
Mussarrat insists on driving at forty miles an hour, no matter how late you are.” 3. “But you were
late in coming home from work and also in leaving Islamabad, and it’s all yours fault”, Aunty
Mussarat answered. 4. “The worst thing for me is living with such a fussy man is you always
have to wait for him to finish selecting his wardrobe, washing his car and combing his hair just
right,” continued Aunty.
180
VU
Lesson Review
Answer each question by telling in the correct word or words in the blank.
1. Words such as each, everyone, and something are ______ pronouns.
2. Words such I, you, and they are _______ pronouns.
3. A _______ person pronoun is one that refers to the person being spoken to.
4. True or False? A pronoun may be singular even if its antecedent is plural. ( ___ )
5. True or False? A writer should not needlessly change from the first person to the second
person. ( _ )
Lesson Review
Answer each question by telling in the correct word or words in the blank.
1. Words such as each, everyone, and something are singular pronouns.
2. Words such I, you, and they are personal pronouns.
3. A second person pronoun is one that refers to the person being spoken to.
4. True or False? A pronoun may be singular even if its antecedent is plural. (F)
5. True or False? A writer should not needlessly change from the first person to the second
person. (T)
RECAP:
In today’s lesson you looked at some more sentence errors and how to improve your written
expression by focusing on – the pronouns, their agreement and the point of view. All good
writers keep in mind these aspects of language and avoid these errors, and you should also try to
avoid making such errors.
Lesson -28
Word Choice
This lesson is in two parts. In the first part you shall learn about the use and choice of words and
expressions, and in the second part you shall look at a number of words that are often mistaken
for one another because they are homonyms – i.e. they are words that are pronounced the same,
or almost the same, but are spelled differently and are different in meaning.
To be a good writer you must learn to use words and expressions that are suitable to the subject,
to the occasion and also for the audience you are writing for.
Even the most casual student of English soon becomes aware of the fact that there are several
different speech levels. Some words are unmistakably bookish or literary, some are informal or
colloquial. Every trade and profession has its own technical jargon. Then there are words that are
used only for humorous effect and there are words that are never used in polite situations. So you
realize that there is a great variety of situations and an equal variety of words to go with them.
Not all writing problems involve grammar. A sentence may be grammatically correct, yet fail to
communicate effectively because of the words that the writer has chosen. The student of
language and literature must take an interest in words. Slang, clichés and wordiness are three
enemies of clear communication. Slang expressions are lively and add colour to our everyday
speech but it is generally out of place in formal writing. Most slang terms are often vague
substitutes for more exact words.
Careful writers avoid weakening their writing with slang. Slang is a living language no doubt, as
new words and expressions are coined almost daily and most of these die out equally quickly.
For example:
Slang: When my mother saw me zonked out on the sofa, she lost it.
Revised: When my mother saw me sleeping on the sofa she became angry.
Slang: When my mother saw me zonked out on the sofa, she lost it.
Revised: When my mother saw me sleeping on the sofa she became angry.
Slang by its nature is informal. Slang is commonly used in talk among friends or colleagues but
is not suitable for good writing or for formal occasions, especially the kind used by and typical of
only one class of persons, such as, army slang, prison slang... As I said earlier, slang may be
appropriate in casual conversation, but it is not appropriate in formal writing.
It is not realized by foreign learners of English that slang is used by limited social groups. Slang
in USA is different from that in the UK, Australia and other English speaking countries. Slang
expressions of the 1960s sound out-of-date or are meaningless now. Use slang only when you
have a specific purpose in mind, such as being humorous.
182
VU
Practice 1.
Rewrite the following sentences changing the expressions of slang by using more effective
language.
1- All the viewers trashed the new Tom Cruise film.
-All the viewers condemned the new Tom Cruise film.
2- I was really cheesed off when Rizwan called me a lair.
-I was really very angry when Rizwan called me a lair.
3- Working in the library has been a real drag.
-Working in the library has been boring.
CLICHES
Clichés: are expressions that were once lively and interesting. However, because these
expressions have been used so much and so often, they have become predictable, dull and
boring. A good writer tries to avoid clichés in his / her writing. Try to use fresh expressions. Here
are some examples of clichés.
Clichés e.g.
i. The boys in my class were down in the dumps because they were fighting a losing battle with
their discrete maths course.
ii. She speaks loud enough to wake the dead.
Iii The children in the nursery class have been busy as bees all day, but they still seem fresh as
daisies.
Wordiness
Some writers show off their command of the language by using big, difficult words. Actually this
is very annoying for the reader.
Notice, for example, how easily the following wordy expression can be replaced by one or two
words.
in order to to
on account of because
184
VU
Look at the following sentences and see which ones communicate well.
1. Due to the fact that the printer ran out of the toner, they went to the local store for the purpose
of buying some.
- Because the printer ran out of the toner, they went to a local store to buy some.
2. At this point in time we have not yet scheduled the date of the next meeting.
-We have not yet scheduled the next meeting.
3. In my opinion, I think the quota system in jobs is totally unfair and uncalled for.
- I think that job quotas are unfair.
To help you develop your skill in choosing words effectively, we will do a short exercise. See if
you can identify errors of cliché or wordiness in the following sentences. Then rewrite the
sentence.
Now we turn to the second part of today’s lesson. We shall look at 20 pairs of words that are
frequently confused with one another. The most commonly confused words are:
(ii) There: (a) in that place (b) used with is, are, was, were and other forms of the verb to be.
Their: belonging to them.
They’re: contraction of they are.
-The teacher told the students that there was no excuse for their failing in the test; they’re going
to sit for another test.
-Their belongings were scattered over there on the hill side. Tomorrow there will be an inquiry
into the incident.
-
(iv) Passed: The past tense of pass
(a) Handed to
(b) Went by
(c) Completed successfully.
186
VU
-
(xiii) Affect: as Verb, to influence
Effect: (a) as Verb, to cause
(b) as Noun, result
- The heavy downpour last night did not affect the success of the trip. The rain had the effect of
clearing the air of dust.
- His speech is sure to affect the voters.
- This film will have a great affect on the public.
- As Principal of the college he will effect certain changes in the curriculum.
Practice:
In the following sentences select the correct word from those given in brackets.
1. (You’re, your) the only person (who’s, whose) never on time
2. (Its, It’s) different to (break, brake) the habit of taking drugs.
3. My neighbours discovered that (their, there) cat had eaten the mincemeat in the pan.
4. The (plane, plain) has (too, to, two) engines, and none was working.
5. The cheeky young man had (all ready, already) decided to (quit, quite, quiet) college, and he
refused to (accept, except) his father’s (advise, advice)
6. The rich (desert, dessert) had to (effect, affect) of giving guests a stomach ache. The host gave
them each a double (dose, does) of soda mint tablets.
188
VU
7. The ladies’ complaints about the (coarse, course) language used in the waiting room (led, lead)
the director to issue a warning letter to the male members.
8. The two brothers have not had any (peace, piece) ever since (their, there) father left them a
(peace, piece) of land.
9. “(Your, you’re) overweight and you almost never exercise”, the physician warned the man.
10. (‘Whose, who’s) application is this?’ asked the office clerk. The young man raised his land,
(wandering, wondering) (weather, whether) the clerk thought his application was well written or
not.
Answer:
In the following sentences select the correct word from those given in brackets.
In today’s lesson you learnt about selecting the right words and their importance in good writing.
You also learnt about words that are often confused with each other because they sound similar.
Lesson -29
Having looked at syntax, at what makes for good, effective sentences, errors in sentence
construction and certain features of grammar, like pronouns and their Antecedents, subject-verb
agreement, we will turn to punctuation. In this lesson you will learn about the Comma and the
Apostrophe - two very important items of punctuation and which cause the greatest problems for
students of English.
Punctuation depends upon grammar. Until you understand how one part of a sentence is related
to another, you cannot punctuate efficiently. Commas are not marks to be added to a completed
sentence for artistic effect; they are very much a part of a well written sentence as are correctly
placed pronouns and adverbs.
In writing, punctuation takes the place of pauses, gestures, rising tone and other such features of
speech.
Most people make use of some system of vocal punctuation in their speech. Some sentences
would be clear enough without any punctuation marks. But readers have come to expect that
sentences that are constructed in the same way will be punctuated in the same way. Therefore,
certain rules of punctuation have come into being, and sensible writers follow them.
The greatest problems in punctuation have to do with the use of the comma, and the apostrophe.
We shall take up the comma first and then consider the apostrophe. This does not mean that there
are no other marks of punctuation: the colon, semi-colon the full stop / period, the question mark,
exclamation mark, the dash quotation marks, parentheses and square brackets are other well
known marks. But we shall focus on only two as these pose the greatest number of problems in
punctuation.
The Comma [,] indicates a very short pause. Writers may disagree about a few of its use, but
most of them agree about the five main uses which we will now consider.
i. Before leaving home the child’s nanny collected a milk bottle a bag full of diapers a blanket
and a rattle.
ii. Although he is eighty my grand dad walks ten miles daily.
iii The cutlery box if I remember correctly is in the big trunk upstairs
iv. The paint company displayed thirty shades of color but the fussy lady still could not find
anything to order.
V. The house agent said ‘It may take you a while to get used to the place.”
190
VU
Answer:
i -Before leaving home the child’s nanny collected a milk bottle, a bagful of diapers, a blanket,
and a rattle.
Explanation: Commas are needed to separate the items in a series.
ii - Although he is eighty, my grand dad walks ten miles daily.
Explanation: the comma separates the introductory phrase from the rest of the sentence.
iii -The cutlery box, if I remember correctly, is in the big trunk upstairs.
Explanation: The words if I remember correctly, interrupt the flow of the rest of the sentence, so
they are set off by commas.
iv -The paint company had displayed thirty shades of color, but the fussy lady still could not
find anything to order.
Explanation: The comma separates two complete thoughts connected by the conjunction or
joining word ‘but’.
v - The house agent said, “It may take you a while to get used to the place”.
Explanation: The comma separates a direct quotation from the rest of the sentence.
Comma Rules
A comma often marks a slight pause / break in a sentence. When you read a sentence aloud, you
can often hear the points where slight pauses occur. These pauses / breaks occur at the point
where one of the five main comma rules applies.
In general, use a comma only when a comma rule applies. When you are in doubt about whether
or not to use a comma, it is often best to leave it out. We’ll look at these rules one by one.
The comma is used to separate three or more items in a series - words, phrases, or clauses may
be used in a series as in following examples.
i. The village women sold pottery, baskets, blankets, and silver jewelry. (Words)
ii. The women spread their wares on the pavements, on doorsteps, and especially under trees in
the town square. (Phrases)
(iii) The tribal elders took part in the dance, their women sold pottery and jewelry, and their
children ran around happily playing games. (Clauses).
(iii) The tribal elders took part in the dance, their women sold pottery and jewelry, and their
children ran around happily playing games. (Clauses).
NOTE: Do not use a comma when the series contains only two items. e.g.
-The college cafeteria now serves sandwiches and cold drinks.
Practice 1.
Answer:
(i) Most countries now recycle newspapers, plastic bottles, and aluminum cans.
(ii) Walking, jogging, and bicycling are all inexpensive exercises.
(iii) The learner driver went through a red light, steered off the side of a road, and ended up on
the footpath.
Practice 2.
Insert commas after the introductory phrase/clause in each of the following sentences.
i. When the lights went off the children let out a loud yell.
ii. During the operation the doctor accidentally dropped the medicine bottle on the floor.
iii. Disappointed by the batsman’s performance the fans threw bottles and fruit peel at the
fieldsmen.
iv. After waiting in the queue for two hours the students were told that the office had run out of
admission forms.
Answer:
Practice 2.
Insert commas after the introductory phrase/clause in each of the following sentences.
i. When the lights went off, the children let out a loud yell.
192
VU
ii. During the operation, the doctor accidentally dropped the medicine bottle on the floor.
iii. Disappointed by the batsman’s performance, the fans threw bottles and fruit peel at the
fieldsmen.
iv. After waiting in the queue for two hours, the students were told that the office had run out of
admission forms.
Rule No. 3. Put a comma around words that interrupt the flow of a sentence.
Sometimes sentences contain material that interrupts the flow of thought. Such words or group of
words should be set off from the rest of the sentence by commas. e.g. My mother, who is very
old, complains that I do not give her enough time.
One way of testing the interruption of the flow of thought is to read aloud such a sentence.
If you read aloud the above sentence you can hear the words “who is very old” interrupt the flow
of thought. Such interruption often contains information that is less important to the sentence.
Examples:
-The owner of the house, grumbling angrily, came out of the house to claim his dog.
-The college, which was built in 1937, needs a face lift.
-The college auditorium, though, is in fairly good condition.
Practice 3.
Insert commas around the interrupting words in each of the following sentences.
i. The house built of white stone was finally completed in 1890.
ii. the park forty acres of prime land provides a fine view for the surrounding buildings.
iii. The scenery of Switzerland which resembles that of Kashmir inspired him to write his novel.
iv. Laila who was wearing a new dress yelled at the boys who spilled tea on her.
When two complete thoughts are combined into one sentence by a joining word like and, but or
so, a comma is used before the joining word.
Examples:
-Multan is one of the oldest cities in Pakistan, and it is also one of the most interesting.
- Some historians claim that Uch Sharif, another city in Punjab is older, but all agree that the
Indus Valley has been continuously inhabited for thousands of years.
-Perhaps you have read about this old city, or perhaps you have even visited Uch Sharif.
-Money may not buy happiness, but it definitely makes misery bearable.
NOTE: Do not add a comma just because a sentence contains the word and, but or so. A comma
is used only when the joining word comes between two complete thoughts. Each of those
thoughts must have its own subject and verb. e.g.
i- Shama spent the morning in the college, and then she went to the civil secretariat. (Comma:
each complete thought has a subject and a verb. Shama spent; and she went)
ii- Shama spent the morning in the college and then went to the civil secretariat. (No comma is
needed here, because the second thought is not complete, and it doesn’t have its own subject.)
Practice 4: Insert commas before the joining words in the following sentences.
(i) The cricket team has lost five matches in a row but they are as popular as ever.
(ii) Kauser wasn’t wearing her reading glasses so she couldn’t read the fine print in the
dictionary.
5. I used to be able to play the sitar very well but now I’m out of practice.
6. It is not a festival precisely nor is it a village fair.
Answer:
Practice 4: Insert commas before the joining words in the following sentences.
(i) The cricket team has lost five matches in a row, but they are as popular as ever.
(ii) Kauser wasn’t wearing her reading glasses, so she couldn’t read the fine print in the
dictionary.
(iii) I used to be able to play the sitar very well, but now I’m out of practice.
(iv) It is not a festival precisely, nor is it a village fair.
Commas are used to separate directly quoted material from the rest of the sentences.
Examples:
-The coach shouted, “Move, move fast.”
- The student said, “Do you mind if I ask a question?”
-The customer grumbled to the waiter, “This tea tastes like ditch water.”
Note: When the comma comes at the end of directly quoted words, it is included within the
quotation marks. e.g. - “After this class,” whispered one student to her friend, “let’s go to the
cafeteria.”
Practice 5. Insert commas to set off quoted material in the following sentences.
(i) “We are ready to leave” said a cheerful voice on the bus mike.
(ii) “This book” complained the student to the book store owner “is twenty rupees cheaper at the
other store.”
(iii) The cashier said “We don’t take cheques.”
Answer:
Practice5. Insert commas to set off quoted material in the following sentences..
(i) “We are ready to leave”, said a cheerful voice on the bus mike.
(ii) “This book,” complained the student to the book store owner “is twenty rupees cheaper at the
other store.”
(iii) The cashier said, “We don’t take cheques.”
194
VU
Review: See if you can recognize which comma rule applies to each sentence. Then identify the
place where the comma(s) is / are required.
Look at the following sentences and see if you can spot the word that needs the apostrophe.
1. it’s impossible to see stars in daylight.
- It’s the contraction of the words it is. The apostrophe takes the place of letter i, which has been
dropped.
2. The judge can’t hear the case until next month.
- Can’t is the contraction of the word cannot. The apostrophe shows that two letters (n, o) have
been left out.
3. No one likes the college principal’s new attendance rules.
The apostrophe plus s shows that the new rules belong to the principal. The apostrophe comes
after the last letter of the word principal. Likes does not take an apostrophe, because it is not
possessive. It is a verb.
A contraction is formed when two words are combined to make a new word. The apostrophe
takes the place of the letter or letters that are omitted when forming the contraction. Here are a
few common contractions.
Contractions are commonly used in every day speech and writing. They are not slang. Some
people in Pakistan think using contractions is wrong. Read out a passage and you will notice how
frequently words are contracted.
Wouldn’t you like to go to the movies tonight? There’s a film I’ve been wanting to see, but it
hasn’t been in Lahore until now. You’ve been wanting to see it too, haven’t you? Shouldn’t we
ask the others to go with us? They’re always saying they’ve plenty of free time, don’t they?
There are 4 pairs of words that can cause problems to students. These are:
1. They’re-(meaning they are) and their (meaning belonging to them)
2. It’s (meaning it is or it has) and its meaning belonging to it.
3. You’re (meaning you are) and your meaning belonging to you
4. Who’s (meaning who is) and whose meaning (belonging to whom)
Notice how each of these words is used in the sentences that follow.
1. They’re their
2. It’s its
3. You’re your
4. Who’s whose
-They’re upset about the damage done to their new car.
- It’s a shame that the college failed to honor its own faculty.
-Your parents said you’re their favourite child.
196
VU
- They’re (they are) upset about the damage done to their new car. (car belonging to them).
- It’s (it is) a shame that the college failed to honor its own faculty.
-Your parents (belonging to you) said you’re (you are) their favorite child.
-Who’s (who is) the person whose care number plate is missing.
In the following phrases the apostrophe and s [’s] are used to show possession of singular or
plural norms not ending in s.
The possessive and plural forms of words are often confusing. Remember that a plural is formed
simply by adding an s to a word; no apostrophe is used. Look at the following sentence to see
which words are plural and which are possessive:
- Samina’s new boots have golden buckles.
+boots, buckles -plural. More than 1 boot, buckle + Samina’s: the word with the apostrophe plus
s, is possessive: i.e. Samina owns the boots.
- also many verbs end with an S. e.g. He owns the cinemas . Owns is a verb. Do not put an
apostrophe in a verb.
Practice 6.
Answer:
Practice 6.
Add an apostrophe
(i)The mood of the department’s head is much better after he gives out the assignments for the
day.
Department’s – head belonging to the dept.
Gives – Verb. Assignments - Plural
(ii) This year’s new television shows are much worse than the programs of last year.
Year’s - belonging to this year. Shows - pl, programs: pl,
(iii) Mind your p’s and q’s.
198
VU
Lesson -30
In this lesson and the following couple of lessons, you will learn the principles of writing. We
will begin with how to write an effective paragraph and the principles you learn here will help
you to write longer essays/papers.
Writing is not easy, especially in a foreign language. Writing is, in fact, a process. It is done in a
series of steps & stages. It is a skill that comes with great effort, hard work and practice. If you
want to learn how to write, you can.
The first thing of concern in writing is content i.e. what you have to say - your ideas, thoughts
and feelings. Unfortunately, some students are so conscious about rules and mistakes that they do
not focus on what they want to say. Rules do matter but not at the beginning stage. Now students
in Pakistan have a fear of English, especially while writing because they have never learned how
to write. They resort to learning model essays and answers to questions by heart. Your attitude in
this respect is very crucial and important. It is your attitude that will determine how much effort
you will put in learning to write.
We will begin with a paragraph. A paragraph is a series of sentences about one main thought,
idea or point. The paragraph is like a sentence in the sense that it must concern itself with one
thought. While some ideas can be adequately treated in a single sentence, others require the fuller
treatment which is afforded by a series of sentences (i.e. the paragraph) or a group of paragraphs,
chapters, section(s) or even a book. A paragraph typically starts with a point and the rest of the
paragraph provides details to support and develop that point.
i) It is best to state the point in the first sentence. The sentence that expresses the main idea or
point of a paragraph is called the TOPIC SENTENCE. The topic sentence is a general statement
and the other sentences provide support for the general statement. If you recall the beginning of
the course, you had a lesson or two on identifying the topic sentence and its supporting details.
ii) To support the point, you need to provide specific reasons, examples, & other details that
explain & develop the point.
iii) You can organize the supporting details in a paragraph in two ways. You can use a listing
order (first of all, secondly next in addition.) or time order (first, next, and finally.)
iv) If you use correct spelling & follow grammar, punctuation & usage rules, your sentences will
be clear & well written.
Look at the following two passages. Notice how the topic sentence which is underlined is
supported by the sentences that follow. The first passage is written by a student. The second one
is written by a famous writer. Notice how both make a point at the beginning and then go on to
support that point with specific evidence and this is what we are going to concentrate in this
lesson.
My Neighbours
1. The new family that has moved in next doors is quite a noisy family. Ever since they arrived,
we have not had peace for a day. Their young daughter is the loudest person I have ever known.
She pops out her head every half hour from her bed room window and screams for the old man
who works for them. Cries of ‘Babaji! Babaji!’ resound in the area. Then the whole
neighborhood can hear what she wants Babaji to fetch her from the market. As for the other
children they are no better.
Screaming and shouting at the top of their voices, they play hide and seek late into the night, and
their dogs, barking loudly, join them in their sport. As if this is not enough, just when the
neighborhood is about to turn in for the night, loud stereo music blares form their house, shaking
and rattling everyone's nerves. I think we need to call a meeting of the other neighbors and do
something about this.
2. On the day after the burial of a celebrated man, his friends and enemies apply themselves to
the work of writing his biography. His school fellows relate in the newspapers his boyish pranks,
another man recalls exactly, and word for word, the conversation he had with him twenty years
ago. The lawyer, who manages the affairs of the deceased, draws up a list of the different offices
he has filled, his titles, dates and figures, and reveals to the matter-of-fact readers how the money
left has been invested and how the fortune has been made; the grand nephews and second
cousins publish an account of his acts of humanity, and the catalogue of his domestic virtues.
- Taine, History of English Literature
Some writers like to start with an idea and then collect evidence to support it. Evidence is
supporting materials – statistics, examples, comparisons, contrasts, causes, effects, and expert
opinion. Other writers like to start with facts on a topic and then form their ideas from those
facts. Still others like to work with ideas and evidence at the same time. They shape their ideas as
new facts turn up and collect new evidence as they find fresh ideas.
Practice 1:
Arrange the ideas and evidence in logical order, the most general coming first.
1
A. The first shelf was crammed with copies of the daily newspapers, The Pakistan Times, The
2
News, The Dawn and The Nation. To the left of the papers, he had piled copies of The Herald,
3
She, The Friday Times and Mag. On the middle shelf, he had a set of the great Urdu and
Punjabi classics and a vast collection of science fiction novels and detective stories.
200
VU
4 5
On the top shelf, he had numerous new volumes on cooking, gardening and travel. His library
testified to the breadth of his reading habits.
Idea _____________________________
Evidence _________________________
Sentence 5
_________________________
_________________________
_________________________
Practice 2:
1 2
Mathematics has never been easy for me. Now that I am in college, I am having trouble
3
getting through even in business math. I never could solve the mysteries of X’s and Y’s, sines
4 5
and cosines. In primary school, I had serious trouble learning the simplest arithmetic. In high
6
school, I barely passed in algebra and trigonometry. My father threatened to take me out of
school if didn’t learn to add correctly.
Evidence _________________________
________________________
________________________
________________________
Practice 3:
Select the most appropriate conclusion you might infer from the evidence given. Place the
number of the conclusion you select in the blank space.
1. Evidence: My four-year old Suzuki has 80,000 miles on it. It needs a new battery, the
alignment of the front wheels is out, the shock absorbers are weak and the upholstery is
frayed._______
Conclusion: 1) Japanese cars give good service for 80,000 miles then break down. 2) It’s time
for me to get a new Suzuki. 3) My four-year old Suzuki needs some minor repairs.
2. Evidence: The rainfall in Dhaka was 88.6 inches in 1960, 86.2 in 1961, 84.2 in 1962, 81.2 in
1963, 80.1 inches in 1964 and 75.1 inches in 1965._____
Conclusion: 1) Dhaka rainfall declined steadily between 1960 and 1965. 2) Dhaka rainfall
eventually returned to normal. 3) Dhaka rainfall was 74.1 inches in 1967.
Practice 4:
Identify the evidence that does not support the conclusion. Place the number of the
irrelevant evidence in the blank below the evidence. If all of the evidence is irrelevant, leave
the blank empty.
Conclusion: The trees in the back yard provide shade all day.
Evidence: 1) Four neem trees to the front of the south side protected the yard form the morning
sun. 2) A row of towering eucalyptus trees on the west side protect the yard from the evening
sun. 3) Two great rubber trees further back on the south side caught the noon and early afternoon
rays.
4) Between the trees were low growing rose bushes, Hibiscus and jasmine bushes.
As I stated earlier writing usually takes place in steps. These are
(1) Brainstorming (2) Making brief outline (3) Writing first draft (4) Revising (5) Proof reading
Step I: Brainstorming
(a) Jot down points or ideas and their details as they come to your mind. Just write them down
without putting them in any special order. Try to accumulate as many details as you can think of.
(b) Clustering is another strategy. Begin by stating your subject in the center of a blank sheet of
paper. Then as ideas come into your mind put them in boxes/circles around the subject/topic.
TV
stereo
something needs to be done
202
VU
Lesson -31
Writing: Paragraph
In the last lesson we started to look at paragraph writing. We considered different parts of a
paragraph, and we examined the paragraph My Neighbours. We noted that a good paragraph has
three major structural parts: a topic sentence, supporting sentences and a concluding sentence.
In addition to the three structural parts of a paragraph, a good paragraph also has the elements of
unity and coherence.
First we will look at the first element UNITY. By unity we mean that only one main idea is stated
in the topic sentence and the coherence that follows each and every supporting sentence develops
that idea. If you are writing on Dreams and you say in your topic sentence that you are going to
discuss two important characteristics of dreams, then discuss only these two characteristics only.
Do not discuss anything else such as what you dreamt the night before or if you were writing on
Television, and in your topic sentence you say that you are going to discuss the effects of TV on
society, then discuss only that. Do not discuss anything else such as the invention of television.
The second element of importance in a paragraph is COHERENCE. By coherence we mean that
your paragraph is easy to read and understand because (i) the supporting sentences are in some
kind of logical order and (ii) your ideas are connected by the use of appropriate transitional
words. We shall look at the topic sentence from the following points
Characteristics
Position
Practice: to recognize topic sentences
Parts of topic sentences
Writing topic sentences
Practice: Writing concluding sentence
Review:
Topic sentence: Remember the earlier reading lessons in which we have discussed the topic
sentence in detail. You have looked at the topic sentence from the readers’ point of view. Now
you will work at it from the writer’s point of view. The topic sentence is the most important
sentence in a paragraph as it indicates what the paragraph is going to discuss, and for this reason
it is a helpful guide, both for reader and writer.
(b) A topic sentence contains a topic as well as a controlling idea. i.e. first it names the topic and
then it limits the topic to a specific area that is to be discussed in the paragraph.
For Example:
-Driving on the motor way requires skill and agility.
- Platinum, a precious metal is used for two purposes.
Notice that these 2 sentences are general statements; they do not contain any specific details.
The topic sentence may appear anywhere in the paragraph. It is usually the first or the last
sentence of the paragraph. The topic sentence may also be the first and the last sentence of the
paragraph. Let us look at three paragraphs:
I) My study table is well organized. I keep ball point pens and coloured pencils in the top right
drawer. Writing paper is in the middle right drawer. The bottom right side has all the other
material I might need, from paper clips to staples and tapes. The top of the desk is clear, except
for a study lamp and a monthly planner. The left side of the desk has two drawers. The bottom
one is a file drawer, where I keep my lecture notes from each class. And in the top drawer?
That’s where I keep peanuts, raisins, chocolates and chewing gum that I snack on while I study.
Here you notice the paragraph begins with a topic sentence “My study table is well organized”.
The first sentence is a general statement. The main idea-that the writer’s desk is well organized -
is in the first sentence. The rest of the sentences show us how well organized the desk is.
2) Do you have problems with sleeping? By following a few single guidelines many sleep
problems can be avoided. First, don’t drink tea or coffee close to bedtime. Next, do not exercise
at least three hours before bedtime. Lastly, work out a sleep routine. Try to go to bed at the same
time and try to get up at the same.
Here the first sentence introduces the topic of sleep problems by asking a question. A question
can never be a topic sentence. It is not making a statement. The second sentence “By following a
few simple guidelines many sleep problems can be avoided” states the author’s main idea about
that topic.
Topic sentences may even come later than the second sentence. See if you can find the topic
sentence in the following paragraph.
(3) Today world-wide communications are taken for granted. Through telephone, TV and the
internet, we learn instantly what happens all over the world. In ancient times, however, military
leaders relied on a much slower, less technical method of sending important messages - pigeons.
Homing pigeons are trained to return home from long distances. The birds were kept in cages at
the military camps. When a message had to be sent, it was tied to the bird’s leg. The bird was
then released and it flew back to its base camp after delivering the message.
At first glance, sentence 1 appears to state the main idea as sentence 2 gives examples of the
world-wide communication. But it isn’t. Sentence 3 which also states a general idea, but points
the reader towards another direction (as signaled by the word however) Sentences 4, 5, 6 and 7
204
VU
provide details to support it. It becomes clear that sentences 1 & 2 lead up to the true main idea
of the paragraph which is stated in sentence 3. This is clear because sentences 4, 5 and 6 all give
information that explains in detail the general statement in sentence 3.
Sometimes a topic sentence may end a paragraph. When this is so the previous sentences build
up to the main idea. Here is an example of a paragraph in which the topic sentence comes last.
Probably in the coming decade there will be more use of home computers. People will use them
to shop, to cast votes, file taxes, and take college and university exams. Also, they will be used
for playing games. Experts say the work week will be reduced to less than thirty-two hours.
Moreover, robots will not only take over many routine service jobs but many dangerous jobs as
well. As these forecasts suggest, the coming decade is likely to be a decade of home computers.
Review 1- To find out what you have learned so far, answer each of the following questions.
Fill in the blank or put a tick mark against the answer you think is correct.
2. To find the topic sentence of a paragraph, look for a general statement. True/False
3. The supporting details of a paragraph are more general than the main idea. True/False
4. The topic sentence may appear in a paragraph (a) only once (b) more than once?
5. When the main idea is stated in the last sentence of a paragraph, it is likely to be:
(a) A summary
(b) A conclusion
(c) Either a or b
Now we shall turn to the parts of a topic sentence. A topic sentence has two essential parts-the
topic and the controlling idea. The topic (names) the subject or main idea of the paragraph.
The controlling idea makes a specific comment about the topic, which indicates what the rest of
the paragraph will be about. It limits the topic to a specific aspect of the topic that will be
discussed in the paragraph. e.g.
- Driving in Lahore requires skill and nerves of steel.
- Living in an English speaking country improves English of a foreign student.
- Sri Lanka is famous for its tea gardens.
- Television commercials are misleading.
Now you will have some practice in writing topic sentence. Keep the given points in mind.
(i) A topic sentence should be neither too general nor too specific.
(ii) It should not unhide too many unrelated ideas e.g. Sri Lanka is famous for its temperate
climate, its many tea gardens and its ancient temple.
(Too many controlling ideas would require 3 separate paragraphs)
Write a topic sentence for each of the following topics. Include both a topic and a
controlling idea
1. The effect of TV on children
2. Books on travel/Travel Books
3. Gardens
4. Popular Entertainment (general subject)
5. The Benefits of Foreign Travel
The following examples illustrate two different types of concluding sentences. The concluding
sentence may repeat the main idea of the topic sentence in different words or it may summarize
the main points of the paragraph which are not stated in the topic sentence.
Examples:
(I) Synonyms: Most people think of ‘synonyms’ as words ‘having the same meaning’, but it is
easy to show that synonyms are always partial, never complete. ‘Tall’ and ‘high’ are usually
considered synonyms while we can have both a tall building and ‘a high building’ we cannot
have both ‘a tall boy’ and ‘a high boy’. Therefore, we should be careful in choosing words
because many words that we considered turn out not to be really synonyms. (Repeats main idea
of topic sentence)
206
VU
(ii) Some people delight in inflicting pain on harmless little creatures. Such as flies, worms and
frogs. They also take pleasure in killing them. This is very cruel of them. They ought not to do
so, because it is wrong to cause unnecessary pain to any creature. Besides, from being cruel to
little animals, men are often led, to become cruel to the fellow creatures, and they learn to do
very cruel deeds. Whenever a man is tempted to hurt or kill any such creature he should pause to
think how he would feel if any creature more powerful than he, were to do the same to him.
(Concluding sentence summarizes the main 2 points not specifically stated in the topic sentence.)
The scientist is more interested in doing scientific work than in defining it. He sometimes says
that a piece of work or book is unscientific, and what he actually means by that phrase is that it is
inexact, that it is badly arranged; that it jumps to conclusions without sufficient evidence, or that
the author has allowed his personal prejudices to influence his report……... [by scientific work,
then we mean that which is as exact as is possible, orderly in arrangement, and based on sound
and sufficient evidence].
Paragraph 2:
The habit of economy can easily be formed if we have a will to save. The first important thing in
the formation of this habit, as in the case of many others, is to make a beginning. It does not
matter with what sum we begin. We should make use of the first opportunity to make a
beginning; secondly we should keep this habit alive by consistent effort. All this is possible only
by a strong will-power. If once we decide to save, we should start immediately……...
Paragraph 3:
There are numerous everyday words in English that have come from other languages. English
speakers relaxing at home, for example may put on pajama's which is a Persian word. A sleep in
the afternoon is called a ‘siesta’ a Spanish word. When we wash our hair we ‘shampoo’ it-from
the South Indian word champi.
3. Computers
208
VU
Lesson -32
In the last lesson, we have looked at the three structural parts of a paragraph. In addition, we
have learned that a good paragraph requires the elements of unity and coherence. We will first
look at unity in a paragraph.
Unity
A good paragraph has unity i.e. in each paragraph only one main idea is discussed. Unity has two
parts. Every supporting sentence in the paragraph must be directly related to the main idea. This
is the first part of unity. Remember, do not include any information that does not directly support
the topic sentence e.g. if your paragraph is about the ‘advantages of foreign travel’ discuss only
that. Do not discuss traveling locally. To make it better, discuss only one advantage in each
paragraph. However, sometimes it is possible to discuss two or three aspects of the same idea in
one paragraph if they are closely related to each other.
The second part of unity is that every supporting sentence must directly explain or prove the
main idea expressed in the topic sentence. Students often write supporting sentences that are way
off the topic. For example, if you are writing about the high cost of college fees, you could
mentions inflation as one factor. But if you go on to write three or four sentences on inflation and
the difficulty of educating three or four children of a family, then you are wide off the topic, and
your paragraph will lack unity. The unity of a paragraph is determined by the terms of the
topic sentence.
Your sentences must be related to the key terms of the topic sentence. Otherwise, it must be left
out.
Look at the following paragraph. Which sentence does not contribute to a unified effect?
In the following paragraph notice how all the details are unified–they are about the same
subject/topic of the paragraph.
Hamid was a big, bouncy guileless man who slapped you on the back whenever he met you. He
loved to crack jokes and would poke you in the ribs to make sure you got the point of his jokes.
He had a passion for food and a passion for ideas. ‘Now take the constitution, for instance. I
can’t believe that we have made a mess of it. There is only one way to come out of this practical
mess.’ he would continue, examining one idea after another. His strong, protruding teeth would
glisten from far away as he sat in the midst of friends, eating and discussing.
Note the specific terms of the subject/topic and the specific terms of the comment about the
subject. Hamid is the subject, and it is obvious that only concrete explanations would maintain
unity, and not just any vague comment about him. That comment centers round the words, big,
bouncy, guileless, and on his having a passion for food, and a passion for ideas.
In the next example, note the details that have been selected to develop the topic of paragraph are
more specific, more concrete than the topic idea. One thing that you must remember is that do
not lengthen paragraphs by throwing in more generalities.
1- The young Pakistani woman has become a puppet in the hands of fashion gurus. 2- She does
everything they tell her to do. 3- She raises hemlines when they give the nod. 4-They are lowered
when a new look is needed to raise sales. 5-At their suggestion she wears bright colours, and
when they propose dull colors, she takes to wearing drab colors.
It is sentence no. 2 which merely repeats what the topic sentence says. You should not merely
repeat the same statement in different but equally general words. In the examples you have seen
so far all of the details have been equal to one another. This does not happen all the time. The
details of a paragraph may have other logical relationships to each other. There may be sub
divisions and further sub divisions of sub division. For example, if you are asked to write on the
characteristics of a good Pakistani citizen, you may break down the characteristics into three
subdivisions – awareness, knowledge and action. You may provide concrete details for all or
some of the subdivisions. It need not be in the same quantity for each.
A good, effective paragraph should be long enough to clinch its point. How that can come about
will depend on the topic and the audience who is to read depends on the topic and the audience
who is to read the writing. For instance a strong argumentative position might require proof. You
will have to see if the terms of the topic have been discussed.
210
VU
Practice 1:
Here is a topic sentence. Look at its key terms. Then decide which detail would not be
related to the key term.
1. Topic sentence: Folk songs are popular because of their greater realism.
Key Terms: popular, greater realism
Details: a) spontaneous participation
b) Honesty about love
c) Powerful, down to earth emotions
d) Involved with ecology
2. Which detail would not be unified with regard to the key terms of the following topic
sentence.
Topic Sentence: Inflation has affected a varied cross section of the public
Key Terms: Affected, cross section
Details: a) people with fixed incomes
b) Petty shop owners
c) Medicine & hospital charges
d) Overcrowded conditions in hospitals
3. Which detail would not be unified with regard to the key terms of this topic sentence?
Topic Sentence: The pollution problem has increased in great proportions.
Key Term: Increased
Details: a) Cars & buses on city sheets
b) Deforestation
c) Polluted rivers
d) Competition by imported vehicles
5. In a paragraph on Urdu films, which three details would be grouped under a major subdivision
about the qualities of the hero?
a) They can sing and dance.
b) Emerges from fights without a scratch.
c) Can jump from great heights
d) Monotonous plots
6.
Write three sentences that develop the following topic sentence: Modern technology has helped
the housewife.
Key Term: Helped, housewife
1. Save time, Labour, effort-kitchen
2. Cleaner, Efficient, Washing,
II. Coherence
Now we shall look at the second element of a good paragraph i.e. coherence-which means “to
hold together.” Coherence in writing refers to the movement from one sentence to the next which
must be smooth and logical. In the same way in a longer piece of writing the movement form one
paragraph to another must be smooth and logical. In other words, it means there should be no
sudden jumps in thought. Each sentence should flow smoothly into the next. Coherence can be
achieved in two ways.
i) By using transition signals to show how one idea is related to the next.
ii) By arranging sentence in a logical order.
Transition Signals
We have had a lot of transition signals in our earlier lessons. It was from the perspective of
reading. Now we are going to look at transition signals for the perspective of writing. Some
writers think of transition signals similar to the road side traffic signs that tell the reader the
direction he/she has to take. In other words they tell the reader when the writer is taking a
similar route idea (words like similarly, moreover, furthermore, in addition) or an opposite
route/idea (on the other hand, however contrast) or giving an example (for example, for
instance) or result (as a result) or a conclusion (in conclusion).
By using transition words, you guide your reader and make it easier for him/her to follow the
writer’s ideas. Transition words give coherence to your paragraph.
PRACTICE:
Look at the following 2 paragraphs. Both paragraphs give the same information, yet one is easier
to follow than the other because of the use of transition signals.
Paragraph 1:
Students who come to college from high school find that at first they have a few problems. Their
college is usually much bigger than their high school. The new first year student often does not
know any of the students of the higher classes. These students are not always friendly to him/her.
They play tricks on him/her or tease him / her. Before he/she was one of he biggest students in
his / her school; now he / she is one of the smallest. Another problem is that he/she no longer has
his/her classroom. He/she has to go to a different classroom for every subject. The unfortunate
student has to carry all his things with him/her. He/she is not used to this. Our first year student
does not have a class teacher either.
Instead of one teacher whom he/she knows well, he/she has six or seven teachers whom he
hardly knows at all. The boy or girl starting college often finds it rather strange at first.
Paragraph 2:
Students who came into college from high school find that at first they have a few problems. The
main problem is that their college is much bigger, usually, than their high school. Another thing
212
VU
is that the new first year student often does not know any of the students of the higher classes.
And these students are not always friendly to him. Sometimes, they play tricks on him or tease
him. Another change is that before he was one of the biggest students in his school; now he is
one of the smallest.
Yet another problem is that he no longer has his own classroom. Now he has to go to a different
classroom for every subject. And the unfortunate student has to carry all his things with him. He
is not used to this. Moreover, our first year student does not have a class teacher either. Instead of
one teacher whom he knows well, he has six or seven teachers whom he hardly knows at all.
There is no doubt that the boy or girl starting college often finds it rather strange at first.
Each transition signal has a special meaning. Each one shows how the following sentence relates
to the preceding one. It does not mean that you use a transitional signal in front of every
sentence. That would be just as confusing as using a few transitional signals. Good writing
requires that you use enough transitional signals to make the relationships among your ideas
clear.
Choose the transition signal that best shows the relationship between the sentences. Make
punctuation changes as required.
1. A recent article in The Herald suggested ways to reduce inflation. The article suggested that
the prime minister reduce the central budget; ______ it suggested that the government reduce
central, provincial, and local taxes. (however, in contrast, furthermore)
2. The writer said that the causes of inflation were easy to find, ______ the cure for inflation was
not easy to prescribe. (for example, therefore, however).
3. In physics the weight of an object is the gravitational force with which the earth attracts it.
_________ if a man weighs 150 pounds, this means that the earth pulls him down with a force of
150 pounds.
(moreover, therefore, for example)
The second way to achieve coherence in a paragraph is by arranging the sentences in some kind
of logical order. As there are different kinds of logical relationships, there are different ways of
organizing ideas and sentences in a paragraph. Your choice of one kind of logical order over
another will depend on the topic and the purpose of your writing. It is possible to combine two or
more different logical orders in the same paragraph. The two most common kinds of logical
order in English way of writing are:
1- Chronological order
2- Order of importance
The word chronological is related to the word time. Chronological order, therefore, is a way of
organizing the ideas in a paragraph in the order of their occurrence in time.
You could use this order of organization for something as simple as a recipe, and for something
as complex as a history of any movement. However, chronological order is not just used for
historical events; it is also used to explain processes and procedures, business, science and
engineering. A paragraph that explains how to solve a problem, perform an experiment are
known as ‘process’ or ‘how to’ paragraphs.
There are two important points to keep in mind when writing a good chronological paragraph.
1. Discuss the events or the steps in a process in the order in which they take place.
Notice how the following two paragraphs are organized according to time.
The first generation of computers which used vacuum tubes, came out in 1950. Univac I is an
example of these computers which could perform thousands of calculations per second. In 1960,
the second generation of computers was developed and these could perform work ten times faster
than their predecessor. Second generation computers were smaller, faster and more dependable
than first-generation computers. The third generation computers appeared on the market in 1965.
If you want to cook something that is delicious and quick to make, try this recipe for carrot
pudding. First, scrape the carrots (1 kilo) and then grate them. Boil milk (1 kilo) and add the
grated carrots. Let them boil. Add I cup of sugar. Next beat one egg thoroughly; pour the beaten
egg into the boiling milk and carrots. Stir the mixture. Add 2 tablespoons of finely grated
coconut. Mix well. Cook till mixture becomes thick. Turn off the gas. When the mixture cools,
pour it into a dish.
The topic sentence of a chronological paragraph in some way indicates the time order. In the
paragraph on computers, phrases such as in 1950, in 1960 was developed, appeared on the
market, 1965 give the reader a hint that this is a chronological paragraph. In a process paragraph,
such as the one on how to make carrot pudding the process to be described is named in the topic
sentence.
The following are topic sentences. Check with a tick mark ( ) those suggesting a
chronological paragraph will follow. Circle the word/words that indicate the chronological
order. The first is done for you.
Example:
In the past thirty-five years, (developments) in the field of electronics have revolutionized the
computer industry.
1- The worst day in my life was the day I left my family and my friends to come to Canada.
2- In my opinion, television programs can be divided into three types: excellent, mediocre, and
poor.
3- The life cycle of the Pacific salmon is one of nature’s most fascinating phenomena.
4- Gold is prized for two important characteristics.
214
VU
Order of Importance:
The second common way to organize ideas in a paragraph is to discuss them in order of their
importance. This is done in 2 ways. You can discuss the most important point first and work
down to the least important point or you can begin with the least important and end your
paragraph with the most important. The way you choose will depend on your topic and your
purpose of writing; both ways can be effective.
Suppose you are asked to write about the two most important influences on your life besides
your family, and you decide to write about a teacher who had so much influence on you that it
somehow changed you. Here, again, you would discuss the two influences in the order of
importance–how strongly each affected you. Again, as with chronological order it is important to
use transition signals to guide your reader form one point to the next.
Now look at the following two model paragraphs. Notice how they are organized.
Model Paragraphs:
(1) As a child, my favorite food was salted peanuts, and I never seemed to get enough. Every
time I stepped out of the house I would think of some excuse to visit the corner shop which sold
small packets of salted peanuts. I even devised elaborate techniques for eating the stuff. Some I
would eat from beginning to end, starting at the top of the packet and ending at the salty base.
Others I would throw casually into the air, letting them land in my wide open mouth.
(2) For more than 75 years, my father functioned like a well-oiled machine. No matter what
the time of the year, what the weather, he got up at 4 a.m. while it was still dark, and went out for
a long, brisk walk with his dog. He came back at 7 and went to work at exactly 7:30. But then
one day, nobody knows why, the machine came to a halt. My father just lay in bed. It didn’t
matter anymore what time it was. He just didn’t care. His connections with the world seemed to
have been snapped. The lights seemed to have gone out. My father had decided not to live any
more, and that was it.
Choose any 2 topics, one form group A & one from group B and write a paragraph on that
subject. Remember to use transitional signals.
Group A Group B
Lesson – 33
Essay Writing
In the previous lessons, we have looked at paragraph writing. Now we shall move forward and
look at longer pieces of writing which consist of several paragraphs. The problems we
considered in sentence and paragraph writing are also the fundamental problems of longer
composition–the same problems of unity, coherence, and emphasis. While some topics can be
treated in a single paragraph, others require more elaborate development. In longer compositions,
we find problems of arrangement. A longer composition, such as an essay, divides itself usually
into a number of parts. In what order shall we present them? How much emphasis should be
given to each fact? These are some of the problems faced in essay writing.
Now a lot depends on the purpose of your writing. If you are writing primarily to give
information, then you need to be as exact as possible in the interest of clear, logical presentation
of facts. If you are writing to describe something, or to create an image or a picture then you will
perhaps put less emphasis upon accurate measurement and more upon suggestive and revealing
details. If you are writing to tell a story, you will have to decide upon the point of highest interest
and arrange your material carefully to give your reader the feeling or illusion of taking part in the
action.
Writing an essay is not more difficult than writing a paragraph. There is only one difference of
length. The principles of organization are the same for both. Therefore, if you can write a good
paragraph, you can also write a good essay.
Process of Writing
Writing usually takes place in steps or stages. There are five stages or steps in the writing
process.
(1) Getting ideas: brainstorming, clustering & free writing
(2) Making brief outline
(3) Writing the 1st draft
(4) Revising
(5) Proof reading
Step I: Getting Ideas: Primarily from reading, talking to people, listening to talk shows, TV
programs on current issues etc.
(a) Brainstorming – For ideas jot down points or ideas and their details as they come to your
mind. Just write them down without putting them in any special order. Try to accumulate as
many details as you can think of. This is one strategy of beginning an essay.
(b) Clustering: The other strategy is clustering. Here you begin by writing your subject or topic
in the center of a blank sheet of paper. Then as ideas come into your mind you put them down in
boxes or circles around the subject or topic. You will now see a sample of clustering.
(c) Free writing, this is also a very useful technique. Here you just write down whatever comes
into your mind about the topic. Continue writing for some time without stopping to worry about
grammar or spellings etc.
216
VU
CLUSTERING
stereo TV
something needs to be done
II. Step Two: Prepare a rough outline. This is going to be the backbone or skeleton on which the
rest of the writing will be built. It shows at a glance the point of the paragraph and the support
for that point. It will help you to see if you need to do more writing to clarify your main point or
its support. You will learn how to write an outline in your next lesson. Here I will just show an
example of an outline.
Example of an outline:
Biography of a celebrated man
a) Friends and enemies
b) School fellows-pranks, conversations
c) Offices held, distinguished figures
d) Relatives-accounts of his acts of humanity and virtues
(iii) Third step: Writing the 1st draft: The purpose here is to develop the context of your
document. So be ready to put in additional thoughts and details that did not come to your mind
earlier. Do not spend time correcting words or sentences that you may decide to remove later on.
(iv) Fourth step: Revising: This is the most important part of writing-a practice our students are
not encouraged to develop.
Revising means that you rewrite, build upon what has been written to make it better. It is at this
stage that you get rid of unnecessary material, improve on what you are going to retain. A typical
revision means writing on two or more drafts. Here you insert details left out, put in transition
words which would make smoother reading. If you are working on a word processor, take out a
hard copy so that you can see your entire document at one time.
(v) Step Five: Proof reading: This is the final stage in the writing process. It means checking
carefully for spelling, grammar, punctuation and other errors. Use your dictionary for this
purpose. Proof reading is often hard work and students want to avoid proofing. If proofing is
done carefully, it will ensure that your written work looks as good as possible.
There is no single correct way of writing English. Good writing depends on a set of specific
writing skills. Three skills are involved in writing.
(i) Skill of communication i.e. putting your ideas across to the reader.
(ii) Skill of organizing your idea in the shape of sentences and paragraphs.
(iii) Stylistic - achieving the right level of formality i.e. appropriate tone.
Writing is a form of problem solving. The writer has two tasks before him (a) the task of
generating ideas and (b) of composing those ideas into some sort of shape in other words giving
structure to those ideas.
All writing, whether journalistic or academic (a report, an essay, an assignment, a term paper, a
project) has structure. There is first the introduction, second the main body in which the ideas are
developed and third the conclusion.
I. The Introduction
The introduction is concerned with the topic or subject of writing. In the introductory paragraph,
you will state the problem/the issue in a few general statements to attract your reader’s attention
and a thesis statement to say how you intend to treat the topic/issue of your essay. The thesis
statement is just like the topic sentence in a paragraph.
Try to catch the reader’s attention so that they would want to continue reading. This can be done
in a number of ways:
By posing a question
Using an apt quotation
A dialogue
A striking description or image
Making a controversial statement
Developing a historical perspective
Background
Making an appeal for action/change
The second part of the essay is the main body where you develop the main idea with the help of
examples and details. This part consists of more than one paragraph. Each paragraph develops a
subdivision of your topic. So the number of paragraphs will vary with the number of
218
VU
subdivisions. Moreover, you can organize the ideas by chronological order or by way of
importance just as you did for a single paragraph.
In the third and last part of the essay you draw your conclusion. There are many ways of ending
your composition. You should create a feeling of finale /fina:li/. This may take the form of a
summary or review of the main points discussed in the body of the essay. Here you may even
propose recommendations.
Essay
11
111
In essay writing, paragraphs are written and designed to serve as part of a longer composition. In
a skillfully written essay, each paragraph has its own proper place, just as each word has its
proper place in a coherent, emphatic sentence. And just as there is a problem of transition from
one sentence to another within the paragraph, so there is some problem when dealing with a
group of paragraphs. So you can see that writing an essay is essentially the same as writing a
paragraph. The difference is of length.
Lesson Review
3. The sentence that states the main idea of a paragraph is called the topic sentence. T/F
5. In the early stage of the writing process, you should not be concerned with spelling,
punctuation or grammar. T/F
8. Two common ways of organizing a paragraph are using a chronological order and order of
importance. T/F
9. The words first, next, then, also, another, and finally are known as signal words. They are
also called transition words. T/F
220
VU
b. punctuation
c. usage and spelling
d. all of the above
Lesson-34
Essay writing
In the last lesson, we briefly looked at the structure of the essay-a long composition. If you recall
it was said that an essay has three parts: I- the introduction, II- the main body and III- the
conclusion. We shall now look at the introductory paragraph, the thesis statement and the
concluding paragraph in greater detail.
Introductory Paragraph: Students often complain that they have difficulty in getting started. A
lot of time is spent in thinking the first sentence. Now if you know what the purpose of an
introduction is, you would not have so much difficulty.
If you remember the introductory paragraph has two parts: (i) General statements (ii) A thesis
statement
1. Anyone born in the twentieth century will have seen a lot of changes take place in nearly every
aspect of human life. 2. While some found these changes fascinating, others found them
discomforting and they want to return to the simpler, less mechanical life style of the past. 3. On
the one hand, the twentieth century brought about a higher standard of living, along with higher
pollution level, the weakening of human relationships and the diminishing of spiritual and moral
values.
You will have noticed that the first sentence in this paragraph is a very general comment about
the subject, the twentieth century. Its purpose is to attract the attention of the reader and
introduce the topic of the essay. The sentence no. 2 is more specific. The third sentence is the
thesis statement and is the most important sentence in the introduction. Why? Because it states
the specific topic (changes in the 20th century) and lists the major subtopics, that will be
addressed in the main body of the essay (the high standard of living, pollution, and values).
An introductory paragraph may even indicate the method of organization of the essay such as
chronological order, order of importance, comparison and contrast, or cause and effect.
222
VU
Practice 1:
In the following three introductory paragraphs, the sentences in each are not in the correct
order. Rearrange the sentences beginning with the most general statement first until the
introduction becomes more specific. The thesis statement should come at last.
(A)1- Lahore’s heavy traffic problems can be solved by building under and overhead passes
along the canal roads, by improving the public transport system within the city, and by building
rapid transit systems from the rural areas to the city. 2- Traffic congestion is caused by thousands
of cars, vans and buses that come into the city from the neighboring small towns as well as from
the thousands of cars that come from within the city limits. 3- One of the most serious problems
that Lahore faces with is traffic congestion. 4- This huge problem must be solved before it gets
worse.
Correct order: (Correct order from general to specific and finally thesis statement: 3,2,4,1).
(B) 1- However, in others, the nuclear family i.e. only parents and their dependent children living
in one household is the rule. 2- People in different cultures have different systems for family life.
3- In many cultures, people live in extended families in which three generations share the same
house. 4- In all parts of the world, the family system is undergoing great changes. 5 In Pakistan
too, the traditional family system, the extended family is rapidly giving way to the nuclear family
and this could have enormous effects on our society.
Correct order: 2,3, 1, 4, 5.
1-
(C) From observing animal behavior to measuring radio signals from celestial objects in
space, scientists have tried different methods to predict earthquakes, but have so far been
2-
unsuccessful. Earthquakes are the most catastrophic of natural disasters in terms of loss to
3-
human life and property. Despite advancements in scientific knowledge and technology
scientists are still not able to predict earthquakes. 4- This paper will examine the history of the
science of earthquake prediction, then discuss each of the methods in more detail, and finally
present data indicating the success - failure ratios of each method.
Correct order: 2, 3, 1, 4.
Practice 2.
(a)
Beginning from the pre-independence period and continuing through the period immediately
after Independence, the status of women in Pakistan has changed remarkably.
________________ .
Answer:
(a) (Method of Organization: chronological)
(b) Despite the setbacks in the Zia period, the status of women in Pakistan has improved
considerably but it is still very low when compared to the status of women in the West.
_____________________
Practice 3
The following are thesis statements in which both the method of organization and the
major subdivision of the topic are indicated. Each subdivision will be the topic of a
paragraph in the main body. Read the statement and say (i) What will be the topics of each
paragraph (ii) How many paragraphs does an essay probably contain?
(a) The status of women in Pakistan has changed notably in the past decade due to increased
educational opportunities and economic independence.
No. of paragraphs (___): _______
(b)The role of women in Pakistani society has undergone great changes especially in the areas of
political participation, economic self-reliance and job opportunities.
No. of paragraphs ( _) - ______________
- ______________
- ______________
Practice 4
Look at the following thesis statements. The main topic is underlined and the subtopics are
in brackets. Indicate the words or punctuation marks that are used to introduce the
subtopics.
(i) Capital punishment should be abolished not only because it deprives a human being of life but
also because it does not stop crime.
Topic: __________________________
Subtopic:_______________________
Words that introduce subtopic:
Answer:
Topic -Capital punishment
Subtopic -Deprives a human being of life
-Does not stop crime.
Words that introduce subtopic - not only, but also
(ii) Women are likely to live longer than men for two reasons: they lead less stressful lives and
they look after their health.
Topic: Women live longer than men
Subtopic: ____________________
224
VU
(iii) We protect domestic animals because they are valuable to use materially and emotionally.
Topic: _____________________
Sub Topic: ___________________
_________________________
Subtopic Introductory words ______________
Answer:
Topic - Protection of domestic animals
Subtopic -Valuable materially
-Valuable emotionally
Subtopic -Introductory words -because
Practice 5
Complete the following thesis statements by adding topics to them. If you use correlative
conjunctions (both…and, not only… but also) make sure your structures are parallel.
(i) This life expectancy of the average person is increasing because of _______
___________________________________
iii) Foreign learner of English has problems with three sounds: ___________
Answer:
i) This life expectancy of the average person is increasing because of availability of good food,
proper medical care and better living conditions.
(ii) Technology is changing our lives in three important areas: transportation, communication and
entertainment.
(iii) Foreign learner of English has problems with three sounds: short vowels, diphthongs and
certain fricatives.
(iv) Nobody likes watching television commercials as they are not only dull and boring but they
are repetitive as well.
(v) A good teacher must have the following qualities: A variety of teaching procedures to use in
the class, good knowledge and skill of her subject, and concern for her students.
The concluding paragraph is the final paragraph and is an important part of the essay. Here you
tell the reader that you have completed the essay. This is done by either writing a summary of the
main points discussed in the main body of the essay or by re-writing the thesis statement in
different words. After that you add your final comments on the topic subject. As it is going to be
your last opportunity to make your point, you should write a strong, effective message that will
be remembered. Let me summarize for you.
Model Essay: Look at the introduction and conclusion for the following model essay on ‘The
Advantages and Disadvantages of Living in the Twentieth Century’.
(Introduction) Anyone born in the twentieth century must have seen a lot of changes take place
in nearly every aspect of human life. While some find these changes fascinating, others find them
discomforting and they want to return to the simpler, less mechanical life style of the past. While
on the one hand the twentieth century brought about a high standard of living, on the other hand
it brought along pollution, the weakening of human relationships and the diminishing of spiritual
and moral values.
…………………………………………..
(Conclusion) In conclusion, although the twentieth century has indeed given us a lot of
advantages by making us more moneyed, healthier and freer to enjoy our lives, it has, in my
opinion, not made us any more sensible and happier. The twentieth century has also made the
earth dirtier, the people less humane and our spiritual lives miserable. We should continue to
enjoy the benefits of modern technology because they release us from the drudgeries of manual
work and allow us the freedom to pursue our interests and objectives. However, we must make
collective efforts to preserve the earth’s natural environment for future generations. Also, we
should try to build relationships with other fellow beings in this world which is increasingly
becoming more and more impersonal and mechanized. (Concluding paragraph is introduced with
a transition signal in conclusion)
Practice 6
Write concluding paragraphs for the following introductions by summarizing the main
points or paraphrasing the thesis statement or adding your own final comments as a final
message to the reader.
Introduction 1: Modern life is creating health problems. Stress affects nearly everyone, from the
highly pressurized administrator to the busy housewife or student. It can cause a variety of
physical disorders, ranging from headaches to stomach ulcers. Stress is not something that can be
226
VU
cured by self-medication like the common cold. However, it can be controlled. One can learn to
control stress by enjoying a good laugh or going for long walks, and by maintaining warm
relationship with friends, family and colleagues.
Conclusion 1:
In the end, we can say that although stress, a feature of modern life, causes many physical
disorder in the human body, it can be controlled by enjoying a good laugh, going for long walks
and by maintaining warm relationships with friends, family and colleagues. In my opinion, to
control stress we need to cultivate cheerfulness for our own sake.
Introduction 2:
Television is the most popular form of entertainment in Pakistan. People of all ages from all
walks of life enjoy watching television. It has been estimated that the average Pakistani watches
TV for an average of four hours daily. Thus, TV has had a tremendous influence on its viewers,
especially children. Doctors are now of the view that children are adversely affected by
constantly watching TV. This is due to the fact that they do not take part in physical activities,
spend less time reading, and are constantly exposed to a world of violence that can affect their
immature personalities.
Conclusion 2:
To sum up, it can be said that effects of television especially on children are not beneficial.
Doctors think that being glued to the mini-screen for many hours at a stretch and watching
violence has adverse effects. It will not only affect their physical health and eye sight but also
their personalities.
Lesson-35
Writing an Outline
An essay is longer and more complex than a paragraph; therefore, it is even more important to
organize your thoughts and plan your essay before you begin to write. The best way to do this is
by making an outline. In this lesson, we will first consider what an outline is, and then consider
how it can be used for writing an essay and lastly we will have some practice in writing outlines.
Outlining is a useful skill to learn because it can be used in both your reading and your writing.
Suppose you are asked to write about the traffic problems of your city. As you think about the
topic, you decide that there are 3 main causes.
Jot down the ideas:
Traffic is a problem because:
- Great variety of vehicles on the road
- Narrow roads
- Drivers do not obey traffic rules
Later you develop these three points and write the following paragraph.
Traffic is becoming a serious problem in my city…(Name of the city) There are three basic
reasons. First, there is a great variety of vehicles moving on the road. There are fast moving,
mechanical vehicles like cars, buses, vans, motor cycles, motor rickshaws, and there are slow
moving vehicles like horse-drawn coaches for public transport called ‘tongas’, oxen and horse-
driven carts for carrying goods and merchandise. This mixture of fast and slow moving vehicles
is the greatest of traffic problems. Moreover, the number of these vehicles has risen considerably
in the recent years.
Another reason is that roads are old and narrow. As cars are parked along the side of these roads,
it makes the roads more narrow, leaving little room for the main traffic to move smoothly. Third,
as many drivers in my city do not obey traffic rules, the result is the traffic jams from cars going
one way and buses going the opposite way on the same road. Thus, there is chaos on the roads of
my city.
228
VU
Now a reader, who reads the above paragraph, can easily make out the outline of its organization
which would be something like this:
Traffic problems:
1. Great variety of vehicles
- fast moving
- slow moving
2. Narrow streets = cars parked on sides
3. Drivers do not obey traffic rules.
From this example, you can see that an outline has two purposes:
(i) In writing, its purpose is to organize and present ideas effectively
(ii) In reading, its purpose is to analyze the organization and relationship of ideas.
Look at the first example of an outline. Suppose you were asked to write on the works of
Shakespeare. Now that is a vast topic. The easiest way would be to make a list of all that
Shakespeare wrote. He wrote plays, and poetry. So you have already classified his work- plays
and poetry. You can further classify or divide his plays into three categories- tragedies, comedies
and histories. In the same way, you can divide his poetry into categories: long poems and
sonnets.
7. Richard III
You noticed the names are the same in the first and the second list, but the second list is clearer.
Why? Because the titles are listed and organized in a meaningful way. The titles are grouped
according to similar characteristics under 5 main headings: comedies, tragedies, histories, poems
and sonnets. This kind of organization helps in making the differences clear and in focusing on
one particular difference or category at a time.
Here are two more examples of topic outlines. Notice the difference between the two.
A B
Example (A) is a poor topic outline as it is confused; the main topics are not of equal importance
outline. Example (B) is a good topic outline.
In the two examples of topic outlines–Works of Shakespeare and Books I Enjoy Reading, the
topics are arranged in a logical order. You have noticed that only topics are given and each topic
230
VU
begins with a capital letter. Because they are topics and not full sentences a full stop/period has
not been used at the end of each topic.
Each topic of the same rank is expressed in the same grammatical form. Also, notice the
indentation and the same system of numbers or letters that are used. The method of outlining is
presented in brief for you.
I. Value of Travel
‘Travel in the younger sort is part of education; in the elder, a part of experience’--Bacon
A. Knowledge from books e.g. ‘From Oxus to Jumna
B. Knowledge from experience–visiting Iran, Afghanistan
Pleasures of Travel
A. Seeing new place
1. Cities, buildings
2. Countryside
3. Historical sites
On the left hand side are a series of ideas on the subject of ‘Flower Arrangement.’ On the right is
a framework for an outline. Using the material on the left, complete this outline.
232
VU
In the following the main headings overlap. Write two corrected versions of the outline:
History of the Punjab 1) History of the Punjab
I. Period before 1500 I.………………………
II. Moghuls II………………………
III. Sikhs III………………………
IV. Period after 1947 IV………………………
2) I Moghuls
II……………………….
III………………………
IV………………………
Lesson-36
Students are asked to write essays on all the subjects they study. It is part of your academic work.
You write essays for English, Statistics, Psychology, Economics, etc. So, do not think that essays
are written for English only. You will be required to write essays for other subjects as well.
Today’s lesson is divided into three parts. First, we shall deal with choosing the essay topic,
second, with analyzing essay titles and last, with taking notes for essay writing. Students are
usually handed a list of essay topics to write by their teachers. Since a lot of energy and interest
is invested in essay writing, it is important to choose your topic carefully. When you first look at
the essay topics, you initially only separate those which immediately attract you from those
which do not.
Are you being asked about your knowledge of the novel (Let’s say ‘The Old Man and the Sea by
Hemingway to explore the nature of tragedy or the effectiveness of the minor characters and the
fish in developing plot and character, or their role in the creation of dramatic tension?
Your teachers read essay topics with care. They know what ideas and what content they want
you to cover in your reading and thinking about the topic. They may even help and guide you
the way in which they expect you to develop your material. Now this does not mean that you
should think that there is only one right way of answering the question. The word ‘essay’ has its
origin in the French word which means ‘to attempt’ or ‘to try out’. And when you write an essay,
you are actually ‘trying out’ your ideas. What I want you to remember is that there are limits on
the ways you can handle the essay topic. Therefore, from the very beginning you should analyze
what it is that the topic demands. This can save you from working hard over an essay only to
have it criticized as “irrelevant”. In this lesson, you will learn to develop an approach that will
enable you to read and make better notes. In this way, you will learn to refine your thoughts as
you learn more about the subject you are writing on.
Most essays in the Social Sciences share certain general characteristics. There are 4 such
characteristics.
1. First you are seldom asked merely to explain or describe a process or event. The task is more
complex as you are nearly always asked to combine description with analysis. For example, look
at this history topic:
Choose any one day’s working session of the Report on The First Round Table Conference.
Identify the speaker and discuss the issues and attitudes revealed in that speaker’s speech? How
would you handle such a question? Would a summary satisfy all the demands made in the topic?
2. Second, you will find that your essays require you to relate general concepts, ideas and
theories to particular materials, events, texts, etc. Or you may be required to move from specific
234
VU
events and instances to a more general interpretation of their significance e.g. take the following
essay topics:
i. Laughter can range from good-humored banter to cruel mockery–How would you describe the
nature of the comedy in Henry IV (parts I & II) and V?
ii. Can the life of the tall Dingas of the southern Sudan living with their cattle be described as a
case of symbiosis between man and animal?
Here you will notice it is the relationship between the general and the particular which you are
being directed to explore.
3. The third characteristic of the most college essays is that they require you to gather ideas and
information from printed sources. Remember some weeks ago I told you that you get idea from
reading books, magazines and journals. It is from printed sources that you will get idea.
4. Finally, you will find that essay topics will involve materials that can be interpreted in more
than one way. There may be a problem or a controversy you are asked to analyze and make an
attempt to resolve. For example, if you get a topic like the following: “Who is freer---The master
or the servant”? It is obvious that you are not being asked to explain in a conclusive way the
nature of freedom.
But you are being asked to consider various aspects of a problem, select the approach, which
seems appropriate to you and to develop it according to a well thought-out plan. So what would
be your immediate concern when choosing an essay topic? Ask yourself: what is the essay
about? In all respects, it would be CONTENT i.e. what has to be put into it. There are a number
of different aspects that you will have to consider: content, concepts, judgment, and knowledge.
1- First you need to check the general area of content defined by key words in the topic. e.g. To
what extent does environmental pollution affect global warning? The topic is about global
warming, environmental pollution and not about the Indus dolphin or the Houbara bustard or any
other near extinction species.
2- Second, you should identify the specific concepts on which the topic is focused.
e.g. to what extent environment and life style of the Hunza people affects their longevity. Here
the essay is about the relationship that exists between three concepts: environment, social
organization (life style) and health.
3- Third, you are asked for judgment. In the light of your reading and your knowledge, you are
asked to say something about the topic-pass some judgment or opinion.
The term “To what extent” implies that there may be some truth in the relationship suggested.
The terms “Why”, “How far you think this is true” allow room for you to deny the whole basis of
the question asked. It is clear that in academic essays there is considerable room for difference in
judgment/opinion.
4- Lastly, I am sure you are aware that essays are usually about different bodies of knowledge,
i.e. disciplines.
There are some topics that are very broad e.g. Photography, Inflation, Happiness, Travel,
Discipline, etc. One of the major difficulties occurs in actually defining or limiting and wording
your topic. You should not expect that you will be able to settle on a precise topic at once. You
will need to read extensively and talk with your tutor before you can narrow down the subject or
topic to a specifically manageable focus.
So the first step must be to analyze your essay topic i.e. analyze the ways in which you are being
directed. Look first for the key words which direct how the content is to be handled e.g. what are
the key directional words in the following topics:
- In the past twenty years (developments) in the field of electronics have (revolutionized) the
computer industry.
-The (causes) of inflation
-Discuss important (religious and national holidays) in (Pakistan)
-The (milestone years) in my life.
-The (Hazards) of driving (small) cars.
-The (quality) of education in Pakistan high schools has (declined).
The task in most college essays is to ‘describe’ and ‘analyze’. The task of describing may be
identified by directional words such as ‘explain’, ‘review’, ‘outline’, ‘enumerate’, ‘list’,
‘summarize’, ‘state’, words which direct you to analyze your material include ‘assess’,
‘compare’, ‘contrast’, criticize’, ‘analyze’, ‘discuss’.
Note making, is a skill and it is also a peculiarly personal affair. You will find plenty of advice
from a lot of people on how to take notes or make notes. Notice the difference between note-
taking and note- making. Taking notes suggests a passive procedure of recording words verbatim
- /v3:beitim/- which means word for word, exactly as spoken or written, like a secretary does
while taking dictation from the boss. Making notes demands your full attention. It requires you
to be alert to the pattern of thought, its direction and development. You also have to distinguish
between what is important and essential and what is not. And it is this active involvement on
your part that makes note-making difficult: This is what makes note-making valuable.
As I said at the beginning, note making is a personal affair. How often you have found your
fellow students who have borrowed your notes complain, that they cannot follow them and vice
versa. This is because you recorded information and ideas which you decided suited your
purpose. Therefore what you select and how you record it one matters of personal choice. You
may pick up a few useful tips from working at other peoples methods, but ultimately you must
develop your own system, which must be flexible enough to meet many different purposes.
236
VU
Think for a moment of the role note-making plays in the process of writing your essay. Why
should we spend time recording the material which is already available in printed form? There
are practical and intellectual measures for this which are as follows:
1. Notes are aids to memory. If you are reading for writing a long essay, then you must
have some system of sorting and recalling information you will need when you finally
come to writing the essay.
2. Your notes are the raw material on which you will work: facts, figures, direct quotations
will quickly be available.
So note making is an important stage in your understanding of your essay topic. It is the notes
that you make which provides the basis for your thinking and the material for your essay.
What do you note, and how much? The content and volume of your notes are governed by three
things.
1. The writer’s intention: You have to shift the information and ideas being presented by the
writer to meet your own specific intentions. The writer presented his ideas according to his
interests.
2- The discipline/subject in which you are working. If you are working on a literary or historical
topic you may need to include many direct quotations. You must copy them with great accuracy.
3. Your own purpose in relation to your essay topic. Do not take down everything-that is just
not possible you would be wasting your time.
Your notes will be more useful if they are shaped from the beginning to suit the demands of your
essay topic.
Your notes will develop their own format depending on your purpose and on the nature of the
sources. There are 4 general principles which apply to all methods of note-making.
1- Clear Identification:
You should record the author, title, place of publication, publisher and edition and even the year
of publication. Next to each key point or direct quotation you must note the exact page system.
Record your notes reference.
2- Develop them flexibly, in such a way that it is easy to rearrange them for the purpose of your
essay; if on loose-paper, then remember to number the pages.
Use abbreviations for common words such as agri for agriculture, govt. for government, sci for
science, C18 for 18th century, C19 for 19th century. Abbreviate names that recur frequently: Q
for Quaid-e-Azam etc. Be careful not to create so many symbols and abbreviations that will
create confusion for you.
The techniques of outlining and note making are related whatever method you choose for
keeping notes. Their form should clearly show the relative importance of ideas and their
relationship. An outline, with its indentation and numbering system helps you visualize the way
each idea is related to the other.
Practice:
Read the following passage. Then read the two sets of notes and compare them.
In this discussion of art history, we give special emphasis to three basic factors. First, the
background: the religious, social, and economic conditions that make art possible in any period.
Second, the foreground: the work of art itself, its style and its variation form other styles. Third,
the contribution of the individual artist reveals his inspirations and the extent of his gift.
There are two wrong ideas we must guard against. First, art history is not a development from
primitive beginnings in the past to final perfection in our own period. Styles change but artistic
quality is more constant. Superior works of art occur in many periods. Second, often one style of
art is the characteristic expression of one period. It is useless to attempt any evaluation between
styles that have little in common. We should compare a work of art only with work of the same
period, as we must recognize that each period posed its own problems and arrived as its own
unique solutions.
Now read the following sets of notes (examples A & B). Compare them. Which one is better?
238
VU
Example A: The author says that there are three basic factors to be considered in art history. The
first is the religious, social and economic background. Then there is the style of the art itself, and
finally the contribution of the individual artist. But there are two wrong ideas about art history. It
is not a development through history: “superior works of art occur in many periods.” Since each
period in art history has its own problems and solutions, we cannot compare works of art form
different periods.
Example B:
I. Three basic factors in art history:
A. Background: religious, social, economic
B. Foreground: the art itself, its style & variation
C. Contribution of the individual artist
II. Must guard against two wrong ideas
A. Art history is not the development through time; there are superior works in many
periods, from primitive to present.
B. Cannot compare works of different periods.
Notice that both examples contain identical information. The only difference is the arrangement.
The main ideas and supporting details are set out clearly in Example B. This form makes it much
easier to recognize the important ideas at a glance.
Study Skills for Students of English 2Ed, Richard C. Yorkey, McGraw Hill International
We have covered the following topics in this lesson: Choosing Essay Topic, Analyzing Essay
Titles, and Note Making for Essay Writing.
Lesson -37
In today’s lesson and in the next few lessons, we shall examine the main body of the essay in
detail and give you practice firstly in using many common ways of organizing texts as a whole.
Secondly, you will be provided with plenty of examples of different types of texts which will
help you to see the principles on which the organization of these texts is based. Learning to write
in English is not as difficult as it seems. Of course, no one expects you to write like a
Shakespeare in a language which is not your own. You are not aiming at writing great literature.
Your need is to write clearly and accurately.
English has a central idea and other related information, and it gets the meaning across to your
readers. Here I would like to add a note of warning. Writing is such a complex activity that it
cannot easily be broken down into a series of skills and sub-skills for teaching. Although no
writing course can ever teach you everything you need to know in order to become a competent
writer. There is no reason why you cannot learn all that is required about effective writing.
In the last couple of lessons, we have been looking at introductions and conclusions of essays.
Good introductions and conclusions hold up the ideas and keep the evidence in order. Take away
either the introduction or the conclusion and the whole structure will fall but introductions or
conclusion do not make up the whole essay or composition. They only give directions and a
sense of finale or finality. Between these two ends of an essay, we use a system. The body of the
essay is written according to a system or a pattern and once you choose a pattern, you must stick
to it. It is possible to combine the patterns in any one essay.
Conclusion Restatement/Summary
Para
There are three main patterns for organizing the body of the essay.
Writing showing relationships:
(i.i) Linear
(i.ii) Spatial relationships
(i.iii) Comparison and contrast
I- Linear relationships
a) Chronological
b) Process in linear sequence
II- Spatial relationships: classification & definition
III- Comparison and contrast
240
VU
Practice 1:
Read the following text and complete the diagram which follows.
As long ago as 1779, John Frere, an English country gentleman, discovered, at Suffolk, several
bones from extinct animals associated with Stone Age flint tools. He published his findings in
1800. Frere’s report was not appreciated for another 60 years. But now Frere is known as the
founder of prehistoric archaeology.
New Scientist, London, 1800
List the words and phrases that demonstrate the chronological order of the above paragraph.
Practice 2:
Put the following information in an acceptable order.
1-
In 1930, the first analog computer was built by an American named Vannevar Bush. 2- This
device was used in World War II to help aim guns. 3- Mark I, the name given to the first digital
computer, was completed in 1944. 4- This was the first machine that could figure out long lists of
mathematical problems, all at a very fast rate. 5- Another important advancement in computers
came in 1947, when John Von Newmann developed the idea of keeping instructions for computer
inside the computer’s memory. 6- In 1946, two engineers at the University of Pennsylvania, J.
Eckert and J. Mauchly, built the first digital computer using parts called vacuum tubes.
Practice 3:
Read the following text and see if you can answer the questions given at the end.
Practice 4:
Look at another version of the same story. Compare the two versions, which is more
interesting?
Ahmed Din Butt was a bright but poverty stricken twenty years old farm worker who grew up
during the Dogra rule in Kashmir. He knew what it was to be hungry and jobless. His father had
died in 1928; he had watched his mother died of tuberculosis in February 1947. There was
nothing to keep him in Kashmir, so, on a cold March morning in 1947, he got into a bus bound
for Rawalpindi. In years to come, he would remember this moment.
Practice 5:
How to mend a punctured football?
Take bladder out of its cover, inflate it a little, dip into the tub of water, with marker let air out,
press to find out the hole mark spot, dry bladder, rub marked place and a rubber piece with sand
paper, apply rubber solution to both, let them dry, place rubber piece on bladder, press the two
very hard.
Practice 6:
Convert the following process into a flow diagram.
The following table gives some sequencing words that are used when describing a process:
Beginning Middle steps End
242
VU
- before this
- At the same time
Read the given passage and notice how the writer uses transition words.
1) Many scientists have worked on solar heating. 2) One such attempt was made in 1949 when a
house was designed which was heated by using the energy from the sun. In this house, energy
from the sun was absorbed by a large area of blackened metal sheets which were covered by
double plates of glass. 3) The air circulating behind the metal sheets carried away the heat. 4)
Before the heat could be blown around the house it was first stored in large tanks containing
Glauber’s salt, a given volume of which can hold eight and a half times more heat than water.
Practice 7:
Read the given sentences and highlight those which carry agent/subject.
a) Rice is harvested out in the fields.
b) Hired laborers load the rice onto bullock carts.
c) The truck cart drivers bring the rice to the factory.
d) The laborers put the rice into the threshers.
e) The rice is threshed by machines.
f) These machines are regularly maintained.
Lesson -38
In the last lesson you learned how to write up a time – based (chronological) sequence and a
linear process – a process that consists of a series of stages and which has a beginning and an
end. In today’s lesson you will still be looking at processes, but this time cyclic, not linear. A
natural process is more likely to be cyclic than linear. As the word itself tells you, in a cyclic
process, there is no clear beginning or end so that the cycle continues. The following two
diagrams illustrate clearly the difference between the two types of processes. A cyclic process is
described in very much the same way as a linear process is, except, it is not always clear where
the cycle begins.
A Linear Process
Input a b c d output
A Cyclic Process
step
step step
step
Practice 1:
The following flow diagram illustrates the Carbon Cycle. The diagram shows how Carbon is
found in the atmosphere, in animals, plants and in the soil. Below the flow diagram is a list of
sentences describing the stages in the cycle. The sentences are not in an acceptable sequence.
Using the flow diagram as a guide, match the sentences with the stages in the flow diagram to
produce a text in acceptable sequence.
244
VU
i) Sometimes, when plants and animals die and decay, bacteria act upon the decayed body and
liberate carbon dioxide as one of the products. ( __ )
ii) Similarly, plants respire at night and give out carbon dioxide to the atmosphere. ( __ )
iii) But this never happens because when plants take in carbon dioxide during the day time,
animals give out carbon dioxide as a result of respiration. ( __ )
iv) Carbon dioxide from the atmosphere is used by plants for photo synthesis ( __ )
v) Sometimes, coal, wood and oil are burnt and this produces carbon dioxide gas which goes into
the atmosphere. ( __ )
vi)
This is known as the carbon cycle in nature. ( __ )
vii) So in this way carbon dioxide is returned to the atmosphere. ( __ )
viii) Carbon dioxide is usually found in the atmosphere, while the compounds such as
carbohydrates, carbonates and bicarbonates are found in animals, in plants and in the soil. ( __ )
ix) Therefore, there is always a continuous cycle – in which carbon is being removed and
replaced in some way or the other. ( __ )
x) If plants keep on removing carbon dioxide from the atmosphere, then very soon the
atmosphere may be without any carbon dioxide. ( __ )
Acceptable order would be: viii, iv, x, iii, ii, i vii, v, ix, vi.
Practice 2:
Study the flow diagram and the text. Some of the sentences should not be there: i.e. they are
irrelevant. Which ones are they?
Sentence No. 2: “Some diseases are transmitted by tiny water animals”, and sentence No. 5.
“House flies transmit microbes on their feet” are not part of the life cycle of the malaria parasite;
therefore, they do not form part of the text.
The above diagram shows how used water is treated and made clean for use. Write a description
of this cycle. While writing, keep the following points in mind.
To explain the cycle, consider the best point to enter it.
Break down the cycle into stages. Consider the basis on which the stages might be defined. Use a
thesis statement in the introductory paragraph.
Use topic sentences for each paragraph within the text.
The following table gives some guidelines on the language available for writers to state then
degree of certainty
Degree of Certainty Verbs Adverbs
Complete is (not) certainly
definitely
will (not) clearly
must (not) undoubtedly
actually
strong
246
VU
following sentences contain the same expression, yet one focuses on cause while the other
focuses on effect.
1. Because of his depression, he remained quiet.
2. He remained quiet because of his depression.
When you write about cause and effect you have to decide for yourself whether the cause or the
effect is more important to you, and what you will focus on. There are many ways of expressing
causal relatives in English. The simplest way of showing cause is: because + clause
e.g The war started because (the extremists had the upper hand in the government).
Practice 4:
Read the following text and note three expressions used by the writer to show causality. Use
(C) for cause and (E) for effect.
When rain falls on the mountains, it collects in depressions in the rocks. The extreme cold causes
the ice to freeze and glaciers to form. The ice melts and freezes again due to / with changes in
temperature. Erosion of the rock of the mountain depression occurs as a result of the continual
melting and re-freezing, and is worsened by / made worse by / increased by the action of wind
moving the water. Eventually, the water wears away the rock to form a small stream which
carries deposits of soil and rock which cause further erosion, gradually enlarging the stream.
Practice 6:
Read the following text and see if you can spot cause and effect words.
Watching violence on TV is beneficial and helps decrease violent behavior because viewers get
rid of some of their own aggressive impulses through viewing and in this way reduce the chance
that they will perform aggressive acts.
In today’s lesson you became familiar with
1- Cause- effect structures in texts and
2- expressions of certainty and doubt.
Now you should be able to identify and express cause and effect accurately and clearly by using
suitable expressions of certainty and of cause and effect.
Lesson -39
In the last two lessons we examined ways of organizing long texts such as essays, etc… We
looked into details at the 4 types of linear organizations:
a) Chronological writing about events in time.
b) Describing processes in linear sequence.
c) Describing a cyclic process.
d) How to show cause – effect relationships.
Spatial Relationships:
We shall look at some of the conventions that are used in the description of spatial relationships
and you will be provided with practice in writing spatial descriptions. The word spatial means
dealing with, happening or existing in space. While writing, very often, we have to describe the
location of a place, how a place is laid out, or how a set of things / objects are connected.
Now you shall look at some ways of describing things spatially.
Practice 1:
Read the following passage and note the expressions which tell the reader where the place
is.
SHIRAZ CENTER
Shiraz Center is a complex mixture of high and low buildings on the edge of Shahdara and the
adjoining locality of Gujranwala, just to the North East of Lahore. Although the site itself was
industrial wasteland, it is in the heart of a residential district. Along one side of it, runs a rail
track, but in every other direction it is surrounded by bungalows and double story apartment
flats. Both Shahdara and Gujranwala are fairly prosperous areas, but Gujranwala in particular,
has undergone extensive industrial development.
There are basically two ways of organizing a description of a place. One way is to describe the
place as if it was being seen from the air - i.e. a bird’s eye view.
The other is to describe it from the point of view of a walk through it, which is known as a
pedestrian's view.
e.g. The sentence ‘Afghanistan is a landlocked country’ seems to be about Afghanistan. In this
case ‘Afghanistan’ is also the subject of the sentence. However, in the sentence ‘To the East lies
Pakistan’, ‘To the East’ is not the subject but is very important information as it locates the
position of Afghanistan in terms of some reference point which we already know.
to the North
to the West
Afghanistan
to the East
248
VU
Practice 2:
Read the following texts and see which is easier to understand.
Practice 3.
Read the spatial description of Lahore and underline the location expressions that are used
to guide the reader through the description.
Note:
Descriptions of spatial locations are normally organized according to conventional ways of
looking at scenes. The most common are:
general to particular
whole to part
large to small
outside to inside
top to bottom
left to right / vice versa
The main point is to be consistent. What ever convention you choose, should be consistent and
you should use it throughout, so that the reader may not get confused.
Practice 4:
Look at the following set of words and put them into groups.
(a) anger love fear emotion envy
(b) table menu waiter restaurant cash register
(c) greetings a wave ‘hello’ ‘hi’ ‘salaam’
(d) sleep, dream, manager, intelligent happy,
teacher.
Practice 5:
The following sentences form a text which refers to the classification chart on FRUITS. Except
for the first sentence, they are not in the most logical order. Try to arrange the sentences
according to a logical order to form a complete text which fits the organization of the
classification chart.
(i) There are three general types of fruits: simple, aggregate and multiple fruits. ( __ )
(ii) Examples of dry dehiscent fruits are the fruits of the African tulip, rubber and pod of the
flame of a forest. ( __ )
(iii) An aggregate fruit is one which develops from a flower with several ovaries. ( __ )
(iv) An example of fleshy indehiscent fruits is the papaya, mango and banana. ( __ )
(v) Each ovary develops into a separate fruit; and so a cluster of fruits may arise from the main
fruit stalk. ( __ )
(vi) The guava, tomato and coconut are simple fruits. ( __ )
(vii) A composite or multiple fruit is one which develops from a group of flowers ( __ )
(viii) The Jack fruit and the Pineapple are examples of multiple fruits. ( __ )
(ix) Both dry and fleshy fruits may be either dehiscent (i.e. they split open allowing the seed to
escape when ripe) or indehiscent (i.e. they do not split open when ripe. ( __ )
(x) Fruits are also classified as dry and fleshy fruits. ( __ )
Writing a Classification:
Writing a classification is based on convention i.e. how others have done it. But it is mainly
based on your purpose in making the classification. Data and ideas are divided into categories
and this is done in a logical way. Some types of order are:
(i) according to time (oldest to newest)
(ii) General to particular,
(iii) Scale:
(a) Importance: most important to least important
(b) Size: largest to smallest
(c) Familiarity: best known to least known
250
VU
Practice 6:
(Sample)
Practice 7:
See how this letter is addressed.
Dr. Ms. A. T. Shah
# 41, St. 27
Mohalla Araian
Sialkot. Punjab.
Pakistan.
The logical order, here is, from the smallest unit (house to the largest (country)
In today’s lesson you learned how texts are organized according to a pedestrian’s view and bird’s
eye view. You became familiar with some expressions of location and learned how to use them in
writing. You also learned how data can be classified and arranged in diagrams and texts. You
should now be familiar with some expressions of classification and will be able to use them in
sentences and texts.
Lesson -40
Writing Skills
Paraphrasing
In today’s lesson you will learn about two things;
1- How to paraphrase
2- To write a summary.
One of the things you have to learn in studying English is, how to express yourself in more than
one ways. This can be best done by practicing in paraphrasing. A paraphrase is the expression of
the meaning of a passage in a different way. Paraphrasing is a writing skill in which an idea (s)
or information written in another way without changing the meaning. It is, in other words,
writing the given information in different words i.e. you re-phrase the words without changing its
original meaning. Paraphrasing is often used in place of direct quoting what a writer has said. It
is a skill and is used to rewrite short selections, a series of sentences or paragraphs. A paraphrase
is usually as long as the original text in order to communicate its full meaning. Here are some
techniques that can help you in writing a paragraph.
1. Your paraphrase may contain some words from the original passage, but try to use
synonyms wherever possible.
2. Change direct quotations to indirect quotations - i.e. use reported speech
3. Change active sentences to passive sentences and vice versa.
Step 1. Read the passage carefully a number of times till you understand it fully.
Step 2. Look up words in a dictionary that you do not understand. Try to find synonyms for
them.
Step 3. Jot down the main points of the passage.
Step 4. Make an outline with the help of the points you have jotted down.
Remember your outline should contain
a The main idea
b. the main supporting ideas or points
c. the primary and secondary supporting details.
Step 5. Write the paraphrase using your own words without omitting any essential idea.
Step 6. Polish the paraphrase.
Practice 1:
It is said that, when in 1998, Brazil lost the World Cup to France; the Brazilians were so
disheartened that one had the impression that a big national disaster had taken place and the
country itself had died. They say that many did die of sadness. Defeat in championship matches
has often caused heart attacks and the despair of the public is usually so great that many take
their own lives. Such is the passion of football fans.
Outline
A Brazil lost World Cup 1998
1. Entire country sad
2. Some deaths
252
VU
1. Heart attacks
2. Suicides
C Football fans very emotional.
Paraphrase:
In 1998 Brazil lost the World Cup to France. The entire country was overcome with sadness;
some people even died. Defeat in championship matches causes strong reaction among fans,
from heart attacks to even suicides. Football fans are very emotional about the game.
Practice 2:
The best approach to students’ co-operation is the organization of thrift societies. The principle
of thrift is as important from the co-operative as it is from the educational point of view. Thrift
gives a basic foundation of character and it is easy to form this habit in one’s early life. In the
process of the formation of this habit, the young student will have to exercise rigorous self-
discipline which will not only have a great effect on his own spiritual life but will react to his
family, and through the family on society as a whole.
Words: Thrift = saving, economy.
Rigorous = firm, demanding, strict.
Outline:
How students can best cooperate -- thrift societies -- threefold value of thrift -- foundation of
character -- formation of habits -- exercise of strict disciplines -- effect of thrift – its deeper
influence, spiritually and financially.
Practice 3.
Each of us is here for a brief sojourn; for what purpose, he knows not. Though he sometimes
thinks he feels it, but from the point of view of daily life, without going deeper, we exist for our
fellow men ---in the first place for those, one depends, and next for all those, unknown to us
personally to whose destinies we are bound up by the tie of sympathy. A hundred times every
day I remind myself that my inner and outer life depends on the labors of other men, living and
dead, and that I must exert myself in order to give in the same measure as I have received and
am still receiving. - Albert Einstein
Outline:
Our life brief -- purpose unknown-- but simply felt -- our immediate relation first to those with
whom we are intimate, then to those we are allied with by sympathy -- the dependence of my life
on the labor of the living and the dead -- feel the duty of give and take.
Practice 4:
Kaleem Omar, the journalist, has studied Japanese business customs and habits. He says that the
Japanese prefer to work collectively as members of groups rather than individually. This, he says,
is one of the main reasons for Japan’s economic success.
Outline.
A. Reported that Japanese work in groups not as individual.
B. This reason for Japanese economic success.
Paraphrase:
K. Omar the journalist says that the Japanese like to work together in groups and not singly. He
believes that this feature is one of the most important factors responsible for Japanese economic
success.
Practice 5:
POEM
Lives of great men all remind us
We can make our lives sublime,
And departing leave behind us
Footprints on the sands of time,
Footprints that perhaps another,
Sailing o’er life’s solemn main,
A forlorn and shipwrecked brother,
Seeing, shall take heart again.
(ii) Removing the inversions and rewriting the sentences in the same order.
Outline:
We may make our lives great--- Departing, we may leave behind us footprints on the sands of
time---There may be footprints which may be seen by a shipwrecked brother and may help him
to take heart again.
Paraphrase:
The lives of all great men remind us that we may also live (make) noble
(sublime) lives and when we die (departing) we may leave records of our actions (footprints) in
this world (sands of time) like the marks of footsteps left by travelers on the sands of the
seashore. These records (foot prints) may be noticed by some serious and grave person (a
254
VU
shipwrecked brother) who has no one to guide him (forlorn) and may encourage him (to take
heart) in his distress or sorrow.
iv) Polishing:
The paraphrase may be written as:
The lives of all great men inspire us so that we also may live noble lives, and that, when we die,
we may leave behind us records of our noble deeds like the marks of footprints left by a traveler
on the sands of the sea shore. These records may, by chance, read by some unfortunate person
who, having made a wreck of his life, is in the grip of despair, and this may give him fresh
encouragement in his loneliness and misery to make a new start in life.
PRACTICE 6 :
News Item
Karachi APP – Rescue workers located the body of a New Karachi teenager on the beach at
Clifton, one day after a sand bar where he was walking with his friends washed out in the rising
tide. Police sources said the body of Mohammad Irfan, 15, was recovered on the beach on
Sunday morning. The body was found 2½ miles away from the area where he fell about 6:15
pm., Saturday afternoon. The boy and his friend, Ali Zaman, were walking on the sand bar with
other teens when the sand washed out form under them, said the victim’s mother, Zainab
Khatoon. Passers-by pulled Ali Zaman to safety, witnesses said.
Paraphrase:
On Sunday, the body of a young man who was drowned while walking on a sand bar, washed
away by the tide and was discovered at Clifton beach on Saturday afternoon. His friend who was
with him at the time of the accident had been rescued by passers – by.
2) The narrowest hinge on my hand puts to scorn all machinery. (W. Whitman)
The smallest joint in the bones of my hand is a far more wonderful thing than any machinery.
3) The main argument in favor of keeping the death penalty for murder is that it will frighten
men out of the desire to commit the crime. In other words, it will act as a preventive.
The main argument for retaining capital punishment for murder is that it will act as a deterrent.
4) There are no gains without pains; then help, hands, for I have no lands, or if I have, they are
smartly taxed. (Benjamin Franklin)
Nothing can be earned without labour, so set to work, my hands, for what land I have is heavily
taxed.
5) No man is so void of understanding as to prefer war before peace; for in the letter children
bury their fathers; in the former, fathers bury their children.
No man would be as stupid as to prefer war over peace; for in peace the young bury the old,
while in war the old bury the young who die fighting in a war.
6) Applicants are requested to state the reasons for any exceptional treatment they require.
(NOTICE AT A HOSPITAL)
Applicants should state why they need special treatment.
7) All drivers and visitors to the hospital are strictly forbidden to park in or on the verge of the
road. Attention is drawn to the fact that a public car park is available in Millat Street.
No parking on this road. Use the park in Millat Street.
8)
Civil personnel will halt here and report their presence at the guard room. They will on no
account proceed further till vetted and granted clearance by the security officer on duty.
Offenders are warned that any failure to observe these regulations will result in detention and
prosecution.
All civilians will report at the guard room for permission to enter. Offenders will be prosecuted.
9) In cases where the school day is terminated earlier than the normal time owning to the
necessity to get pupils home before the onset of monsoon rains, a careful note of the relevant
circumstances must be made and transmitted to the Education Office at the earliest possible
opportunity.
In case the school day is shortened owing to monsoon rains, the Education Office must be
informed immediately.
The Education Office must be informed as soon as possible if monsoon rains make it necessary
to end school earlier than usual.
You looked at different samples of paraphrases – single sentences, short prose passages, a poem,
and a news item.
1.
Paraphrasing takes time. It cannot be done hastily.
2. In a paraphrase on no account, you must introduce anything which is not in the original,
however, much you may wish or want to; that you can do in an essay but not in a paraphrase.
3. Don’t try to change every word of the original. Some words cannot be suitably replaced.
4. A paraphrase is neither an expansion nor a summary.
5. No introducing sentence is needed to begin it.
In today’s lesson you learned how to express yourself in a different way. Paraphrasing is a very
useful writing skill and goes a long way in helping develop your writing abilities.
256
VU
Lesson -41
Writing a Summary
Today’s lesson deals with another writing skill – how to write a summary. A summary is similar
to a paraphrase except that a summary is usually shorter. When you summarize, you compress
large amounts of information into the fewest possible sentences. In order to do this, you include
only the main points and main supporting points, leaving out the details.
A summary or precis (French word which means the same as summary) is a brief and clear
statement in a connected and readable shape of the substance of a longer passage.
Definitions are useful things, even when they make the thing defined sound dull as the above
definition does. The reasons for learning how to summarize are really sensible. They are:
Definition:
A summary or precis (French word which means the same as summary) is a brief and clear
statement in a connected and readable shape of the substance of a longer passage.
As a foreign learner of English any examination you take, the examiners are likely to test your
ability to read, write and think in English. A summary writing will give you;
i) Good practice both in clear writing and clear thinking.
ii) It enables you to express in your own words, somebody else’s ideas even if you do not agree
with those ideas.
iii) Read the passage carefully.
iv) Read the passage again. Note the different points it contains. Number the points.
v) Strike out points not essential to the meaning, repetitions, illustrations, anecdotes,
comparisons, etc...
vi) Arrange the points in a best possible way.
vii) Write summary – first draft.
In the middle ages people had no ideas of scientific farming. Spare cattle were killed and salted
for winter eating. Spices were used a lot. They came from the East. The Turks cut the line of
supply. Voyages of exploration were undertaken partly to find spices.
As people in the middle ages had no idea of scientific farming, spare cattle had to be killed and
salted for winter eating. This unappetizing meat led to a demand for spices, and one reason for
the great voyages of exploration was the shortage of spices when the trucks cut the overland
route of their supply.
Here are some more examples of phrases that would be better expressed in single words:
of a disagreeable nature
of a delightful description
in a brief manner
in a stupid way.
of a silly kind
Here are some more examples that show how easy it is to write wordily and also how the
wordiness might be avoided.
Practice 1:
Writing Briefly & Clearly:
1. It is not without interest to observe, in connection with the duration of the school team, that
punishments show a tendency to increase in number as the term progresses. (29)
It is interesting to note that punishments increase as the school team progresses (13)
2. Having regard to the recent increase in the number of cases of malaria in this area, it is clearly
desirable that the scheme for the provision of more doctors should be put into effect. (34)
The recent increase in the number of malaria cases in this area requires that more doctors should
be posted (19)
3. Two men sustained serious bodily injury when their car came into collision with a truck today.
(16)
Today two men were seriously injured when their car collided with a truck. (13)
REPETIITON:
People seem, sometimes, to think that what they say twice is more impressive than what they say
once. Actually repetition shows weakness, not strength.
258
VU
Practice 2:
Avoiding Useless Repetition.
For three months, the river is in continuous flood; this state of affairs goes on for the whole of
that time without cease.
For three months the river is in flood.
In the end, we eventually agreed to go by the shortest route.
In the end, we agreed to go by the shortest route.
Without warning, unexpected, unheralded, the storm broke on us.
Without warning the storm broke on us.
You can do this by subordinating the less to the more important ideas e.g.
It was quite dark; for the sun had set an hour before and the moon had not yet risen when the
thief carefully opened the door of his house and prepared to go about his business. (36)
(Here, there are 5 clauses, but it is possible to turn many of them into words or phrases). e.g.
An hour after sunset, in one dark, moonless night, the thief crept to his house to go about his
business (20 words)
(Here we have 20 words instead of 36 and the meaning, so little changed as to be almost the
same).
PRACTICE 3:
Shorten the following without losing any of the meaning.
His efforts, although, they were the best he could make do, ended in failure.
His best efforts failed.
His horses, which were two in number, he used for the single purpose of playing polo, which he
was only able to do on Mondays once in every two weeks.
He used his two horses for playing polo on Mondays every fortnight.
1. Working conditions in the nineteenth century seem barbaric today: twelve-to-fourteen hour
work days; seven day weeks; cramped, unsafe factories; marginal wages, and no legal protection.
Yet employers seldom had problems motivating their workers: poverty and unemployment were
so widespread that any job was welcome.
- Widespread poverty and unemployment made nineteenth-century workers willing to put up with
terrible working conditions.
2. Compromise is a common and effective way of coping directly with conflict or frustration. We
often recognize that we cannot have everything we want and that we cannot expect others to do
just what we would like them to do. We then compromise, deciding on a more realistic solution
or goal since an ideal solution or goal is not practical. A young person who loves animals and
greatly wishes to become a veterinarian may discover he has less aptitude for biology than he
had hoped and that dissecting is so distasteful to him that he could never bring himself to operate
on animals. By way of compromise, he may decide to become an animal technician, a person
who works as an assistant to a veterinarian.
-Compromise is a direct way of coping in which we decide on a more realistic solution or goal
since an ideal solution or goal is not practical. For example, a person not good in biology may
decide to be an animal technician rather than a veterinarian.
3. All family systems can be categorized into one of two types. The extended family is one in
which more than two generations of the same kinship live together either in the same house or in
adjacent dwellings. The extended family, which is commonly found in traditional, pre-industrial
societies, can be very large: It contains 3 generations living together. In contrast, the nuclear
family is one in which the family group consists only of the parents and their dependent children.
The nuclear family is the usual type in virtually all modern industrialized societies.
-There are two basic types of families. The extended family, which is more than 2 generations
living together, is common in pre-industrial societies. The nuclear family, made up of parents and
their dependant children, is usual in industrialized societies.
4. Again, when we feel fear of the dog, we learn to avoid similar situations. Finally, emotions
help regulate social interaction. Our observation of other people’s emotional states determines
how we respond to them. For example, if we notice that another person is experiencing fear, we
may be moved to comfort and reassure him.
-Psychologist has distinguished 3 functions of emotions in our lives. Emotions can prepare us to
take action, shape our future behavior, or regulate our social interaction.
Today’s lesson dealt with a very important writing skill – summarizing – which you will be
required to use very often in life. You were given practice in summarizing & shown samples of
good summaries.
260
VU
Lesson -42
In this lesson first, we shall discuss verb tenses and the problems they pose for learners of
English and next we shall examine passive tenses.
In an English sentence, the verb is the most important word. It is through the action described by
the verb that the sentence comes alive. As a result, the verb is the lifeblood of the sentence.
Among other properties, verbs tell time by specifying when the action occurred. This time
feature is known as tense.
3. Present Participle:
It is the -ing form of a verb. The present participle is the form that is used with the helping verbs
am, is, are, was, or were to show continuing action.
- Jo is spreading the sheet on the ground.
As I was gathering the clothes on the line, the wind blew away some of them.
4. Past Participle:
The past participle of a verb is usually the same as its past tense form. The past participle is the
form that is used with the helping verbs have, has, and had and with am, is, are, was, were.
- The girl have asked the boss for a raise.
- The kitchen door was jammed tight.
Main Tenses:
There are six main tenses in English. They are present, past, future, present perfect, past perfect
and future perfect.
The following chart shows the six basic tenses of the verb ‘jump’
Tense Example
Present I jump
Past I jumped
Future I will jump
Present perfect I have jumped
Past perfect I had jumped
Future perfect I will have jumped
It is used to describe an action that is happening in the present or to describe a condition that
exists at the present time regardless of the other verbs in the sentence. Susan works in 1.
Children’s toys are on the third floor. (Habitual action)
2. The neighbor’s dog smells our plants. (Present action)
The Historical Present: The present tense is used to make a more vivid description of any past
actions through a restatement or a summarization of the facts from a book or a report etc….
1. In his report Mr. Farook states that the president will call candidates for interview in a year’s
time.
2. “Revenge”, says the Lord “is mine”. (Bible)
The historical present is used when we write about events or happenings in a work of literature.
The rationale for using the present tense is that the happenings of literature are unchangeable and
therefore are permanently true.
It is used to describe an action or state of being that occurred some time in the past.
1. At yesterday’s party, the host made a rude remark.
2. The goods were delivered late last night.
It is used to indicate an action which is to take place in the future or a state or condition that will
exist some time in the future.
1. According to the college schedule, the examination will be held in the Basemen at 9:00. a.m.
2. If you are to succeed, you will need to set realistic goals.
262
VU
You can form the future tense by placing will or shall before the verb. In the past, the use of will
and shall was prescribed, but in today’s language usage, will is typically used to express ordinary
future tense and shall is used to express a demand or is used with laws, policies or contracts.
The Three Perfect Tenses are formed by adding the helping verb have, has, or had to the past
participle of the verb. The past participle of a regular verb is simply the form that ends in -ed.
4. The Present Perfect Tense is used to describe an action that started in the past and either has
been finished or is continuing at the present time.
The present perfect tense is formed when we add has or have plus the past participle.
1. Marina has worked at a number of jobs over the year.
2. After great efforts by the police, the building has been evacuated.
It describes an action that was completed in the past before another past action. The past perfect
tense is formed when we add had plus the past participle.
1. Marina had worked in a number of TV programs before she joined the company.
2. Before I reached my office, my friend Lylla had returned my call.
It describes an action that will be completed before sometime in the future. The future perfect
tense is formed when we add shall have or will have to the past participle. By the end of the year,
the contractors will have completed the new block.
1. Mr. Saeed will have been employed by the printing firm for 25 years in December.
2. Our secretary shall have entered all data for your report by Saturday.
The Three Progressive Tenses: As their name suggests, these tenses express actions still in
progress at a particular time. They are made by adding a form of the helping verb -be to the -ing
form of the verb.
Practice 1.
2. Pink flowers blossom on this peach tree every spring. Then tiny green buds appeared. Finally,
the peaches grow into sweet red fruit.
Practice 2:
Practice 3.
Spot the verb in each sentence that is not in the same tense as the others.
1. Hafeez rang the doorbell and wanted for several minutes. Finally, when no one answers, he
turned away disappointed.
2. As the campers drove away, they look back and saw their dog running after them.
3. He came home early because he wasn’t feeling well then he discovers his wife had the door
key.
4. Our children love going to the school library because they can take out any book they wanted,
even if they can’t read it yet.
Review:
Fill in the blanks where required with the correct word.
1. There are six basic tenses in English (T/F).
2. They are present, past, ____, present perfect, ___ ___ and future perfect.
3. The past tense is formed with regular verbs by adding ____ or ___ to the basic form of the
verb.
4. The ______ tense is formed by adding the word will before the basic form of the verb.
264
VU
5. The ______tenses are formed by adding a form of the helping verb have, has or had to the past
participle of the verb.
6. The ___ ____ tense describes an action that was completed in the past before another past
action.
7. The present progressive tense is formed by adding the correct form of the helping verb be to
the) -s, -ing or –ed?) ___ form of the verb.
1. The estate
management will prosecute trespassers
PRESENT TENSES
Simple Present:
Jewels are bought by ladies.
Present Continuous:
Jewels are being bought by ladies
Present Perfect:
Ladies have been advised to declare their jewelry in their wealth tax forms.
Present Modals:
Steps must be taken to educate the public about filling in tax returns.
PAST TENSES
Simple Past:
Maps of the rebel’s hide-out were shown to the press.
Past continuous:
Until recently hand crafted jewelry was not being designed locally.
Past Perfect:
Pakistani carpets had always been designed by local artists.
Perfect Modals:
The textile industry might not have been required by the government to pay taxes.
FUTURE TENSES
266
VU
‘will’ - Teaching assistants will be used to assist teachers in evaluating students’ examination
scripts.
‘going to’ - Factories are going to be built in the new export promoting zone.
Future Perfect
- By 2010 the new canal system will have been put into regular use.
USES OF PASSIVE
1. When you want to give your writing an objective and impersonal tone. It is often used in
scientific, business writing and newspaper reports.
2. When you want to focus attention on the receiver of an action. e.g
If you are writing a paper about a discovery, the use of passive will focus on the discovery. But if
you were to write with active verbs, the reader might think your paper is about the person who
made the discovery and not the discovery itself.
Lesson -43
Word Order
In many of the lessons on writing and, even in those on reading, we looked at how ideas are
organized and put together or connected within and between sentences. In today’s lesson we shall
look at the way certain words like adverbs, which cause problems to learners of English, are
placed in the sentence. We are going to look at ways words are positioned or ordered in an
English sentence and give you some practice in their use. The words are:
7. At the end of the road you’ll see a petrol pump on your left.
At the end of the road you’ll see on your left a petrol pump.
268
VU
(1) In English the place (where?) is mentioned before the time (when? How often? How long?)
e.g
1. Huma walks to work every morning.
Huma walks every morning to work.
2. Their family has been in the United States since last year.
3. He arrived at the railway station early.
Practice 1:
(b) Sometimes when a verb is composed of two or more words such as can remember, doesn’t
drive, has / have been eaten; the adverb is put after the first part of the verb.
1 2
V ADV V
He can never remember my name
I don’t usually smoke
Are you definitely resigning?
Your bike has probably been stolen
Practice 2:
Decide whether the underlined words are in the correct order. Use W for wrong and R for
right.
(3) The position of still, yet, anymore, any longer, no longer in a sentence
Still is used to say that a situation or action is continuing. Still usually is used in the middle of the
sentence with the verb. e.g.
- It’s 11:00 p.m. and Sara is still working.
- Are you still living in the same locality or have you moved?
-Do you still want to go to the post office, or have you changed your mind?
Yet is used to ask if something has happened or when we say that something has not happened.
Yet is used mainly in questions and negative sentences.
Yet is usually found at the end of the sentence. e.g.
- Have you finished packing that suitcase yet?
- It’s 11 o’clock and the typist hasn’t arrived yet.
-We’re hungry. Is dinner ready yet?
Yet is often used with the present perfect (Have you finished washing that dress yet?).
Compare still and yet in the following sentences.
- My brother lost his job last year and he is still unemployed.
- My brother lost his job a year ago and hasn’t found another job yet.
- Is it still raining?
- Has it stopped raining yet?
-She said she would be here half an hour ago, and she still hasn’t come.
270
VU
‘She still hasn’t come’ shows a stronger feeling of impatience as can be seen from the following
sentences:
- She hasn’t called me yet (but I expect she will soon)
-She still hasn’t called me (she should have called before now)
not … anymore, not… any longer and no… longer are used to say that a situation has
changed. Anymore, and any longer come at the end of the sentence
- Miss Mir doesn’t work here anymore / any longer.
- They were great friends once, but they aren’t friends any more / any longer.
But ‘no more’ cannot be used in this way. You can have:
- He is no longer our employee. But not * He is no more our employee.
Practice 3:
1. Tony used to have long hair and a beard. (still / long hair but..).
(Tony still has long hair, but he doesn’t have a beard anymore.)
2. Teddy used to play tennis and football. (still / tennis but).
(Teddy still plays tennis but he doesn’t play football anymore.)
3. Mother was in hospital and she was in critical condition. (still / hospital but...)
- Mother is still in hospital but she isn’t in critical condition anymore.
4. I used to like Kathy and Karen (still / Kathy but…)
- I still like Kathy but not Karen anymore.
5. He was a good batsman, and he was the best in the team. (still / good batsman but)
- He is still a good batsman but isn’t the best in the team anymore.
6. I was feeling depressed and homesick. (still / depressed but….)
- I am still feeling depressed but not homesick anymore.
- Although it was raining since morning, all the school kids arrived on time.
- In spite of the traffic jam, the guest arrived on time.
- I couldn’t sleep, although I was tired.
- I couldn’t eat, despite being hungry.
(B) Sometimes though is used instead of although. This happens more often in spoken English
with though coming at the end of a sentence.
Practice 4:
(A). Complete these sentences by using although and a phrase from the box.
It was quite chilly
She had been rude to them.
I had never seen my aunt.
He holds an important office
He had promised to be on time`
1. Although ________he is not paid well.
2. Although ________, I recognized her from a photograph.
3. She didn’t wear a shawl, although ______
4. They decided to invite her to the function, although ________________________.
5. They were late, although ______________.
Practice 4:
(B). Complete the following sentences with ‘although’ or ‘in spite of’.
Practice 4:
(C). Using the words in the brackets make sentences with though at the end.
272
VU
(B) Very often ‘even’ is used with the verb in the middle of a sentence.
Practice 5:
Complete these sentence with even + a comparative
1. I bought a cheap umbrella, but the one Julie bought was ___ ____.
2. This house is two hundred years old, but the mosque next to it is ___ ____.
3. The restaurant is always crowded, but today its _____ _____ ______.
‘As’ is used especially for two short actions, happening at the same time.
As is also used when two changes happen over the same period of time
- As the day wore on, the weather got worse.
- I began to enjoy the work as I got used to it
B) As (time): You can use as to show one thing happening during another i.e. in the middle of
doing something else. When ‘as’ is used in this way, both actions are usually quite short.
- The old woman slipped as she was getting off the bus.
- I burned my hands as I was taking the cake out of the oven.
Practice 6:
Rewrite the following sentences showing one thing happens during another.
274
VU
We use as + N to say something really is / was especially when we talk about someone’s job or
how we use something.
- A few weeks ago he was working as a bus conductor.
- Asad has just found a job as a clerk.
-We don’t have a car, so we use the garage as a store room.
We use like when we compare things.
- She is beautiful like a princess.
(She really isn’t a princess.)
- Everyone is sick in the college hostel. It is like a hospital. (It isn’t really a hospital)
Practice 7:
In today’s lesson we looked at the order in which certain words occur. The words we looked at
often pose problems for learners of English in their writing. I hope today’s lesson clarified the
use of these words.
276
VU
Lesson -44
Now a days grammarians divide English words into two categories - major and minor. In the
major category are words like nouns, verbs, adjectives and adverbs. These are sometimes called
CONTENT words because they carry the main meaning in communication, e.g. they’re the
words that you would send in a telegram “Arriving PK 421 Sunday” “Send money broke”
In the minor category are determiners, pronouns, prepositions and conjunctions.
Minor words express or signal subtle shades of meaning, obvious information, or redundant
grammatical information i.e. words that perform no particular function. Minor class words occur
more frequently than members of the major classes. There are around 50 of these words and they
are very common. All of these fifty words are function words; they make up about 60% of words
that are used in speech and about 45% of those that are used in writing.
These minor words are like bricks that cement together the content words. For this reason minor
words are also known as structure words.
(1) Determiners are a class of minor words. A determiner is a word which precedes or comes
before nouns and adjectives e.g.
- The cat sat on my bag. (art, poss)
- I don’t want any tea. (indef deter)
- Have you some yogurt? (indef deter)
The reason why we are going to look at articles is that Pakistani learners of English make the
most mistakes in the use of articles. They insert articles where they are not required and do not
use them where they are required.
In today’s lesson we shall only examine articles, a subclass of determiners in detail. There are 2
articles in English, the definite ‘the’ and the indefinite, a / an. Articles are easily recognized and
indicate that a noun follows, but sometimes nouns require no articles. While articles have a
single function: they modify or the head noun in a noun phrase, their meaning is quite complex.
Pronunciation: The spelling of the indefinite article ‘a’ and the pronunciation of both the
definite and indefinite articles depend on the initial sound of the word that follows. Articles are
normally not stressed, but may be stressed for the sake of emphasis.
The unstressed definite article is always written ‘the’ and is pronounced / / before consonants
and / i/ before vowels. The indefinite article ‘a’ is pronounced / / before consonants and -/ n/-
before vowels. e.g.
the girl, the pilot, the bridge
the aunt, the egg, the octopus
The stressed definite article / i/ is used to show excellence or superiority in some way e.g. - Is
she the / i / Mrs. Butt?
- No. she’s a Mrs. Butt, but not the famous one.
- This party will be the /di/ social event of the week.
2. Article Usage:
The general rules are:
(a). The definite article ‘the’ can be used with all kinds of nouns except most proper nouns.
sing. count nouns: the dog / child / train
plural count nouns: the dogs / children / trains
Sing. mass nouns: the silver / water
(b) The indefinite article ‘a/ an’ can normally only be used with singular count nouns: e.g.
a ball / child / exams
plural count nouns: (some) balls/children/ exams singular
mass nouns: (some) silver/milk/ knowledge
For other nouns the zero article i.e. no article at all is used for indefinite meaning.
278
VU
When we use the definite article ‘the’, it indicates that a hearer or reader can identify the thing
referred to, or know what is being talked about. e.g.
I saw the film (reader/hearer knows which one)
But this is not the case when we use the indefinite article ‘a’ / ‘an’ e.g.
I saw a film (reader / hearer doesn’t know which one).
If we want to express indefinite meaning of amount, etc., we use the indefinite article a (n) with
sing. count nouns or plural count nouns. e.g.
- Would you like a soda?
- Do you like chocolate?
(zero indef. article with mass noun ‘chocolate’
There are 4 conditions in which definite meaning arises. We use the definite article for: (1)
Referring – Back Use: When identity has been established by an earlier mention e.g.
- Saba bought a TV and a video recorder, but she returned the video recorder (second mention).
(2) Forward-Pointing Use: When identity is established by the post modification that follows
the noun: e.g.
- Saba returned the view-recorder she bought yesterday.
(3) The Unique Use of ‘The’: When the object or group of objects or things is the only one that
exists or has existed such as: the moon, the earth, the South Pole, the equator, the Moghals, the
human race. This unique use of ‘the’ also occurs when the thing being referred to is understood
to be unique in the context. e.g. the kitchen, the town-hall, the President, etc.
(4) Institutional Use of ‘The’: When reference is made to something that is shared by the
community such as: the radio, the telephone, the papers e.g.
- What’s in the paper(s) today?
Sometimes ‘the’ may be omitted in the institutional use.
The definite article ‘the’ has a Generic or Typical use when it refers to what is general or typical
for a whole class of things. This use of ‘the’ is found with count. Nouns. e.g.
i) ‘The’ peacock is a beautiful bird.
Here ‘the’ indicates the class of birds, not one individual member of the class.
ii) Peacocks are beautiful birds. (General use of the plural indefinite form)
iii) A peacock is a beautiful bird.
You will have noticed that sentence 1 expresses the same meaning as sentences 2 & 3. Now this
means that when we are dealing with a whole class of things the difference between definite and
indefinite, singular and plural are apt to lose their significance.
We can say the peacock (generic) refers to the species as a whole, while a peacock (generic)
refers to any member of the species. We can say:
The peacock is in danger of becoming extinct
But not:
A peacock is in danger of becoming extinct.
Let us look at the use of the definite article with nouns. The following table illustrates the ways
of expressing generic meaning.
the peacock
a peacock water
peacocks
But see how the following nouns take the definite article.
Specific use Generic use
a) Pass the butter please. Butter is imported now a day.
b )The acting was poor but I simply love acting and music.
the music was super.
Notice that in English, mass nouns and plural nouns are treated as generic and they do not take
the definite article. When these nouns (mass & plural) are modified by an – of phrase the definite
article is normally used, especially with abstract mass nouns.
280
VU
We find that with concrete mass nouns and plural nouns ‘the’ can be omitted as in
-eighteenth century furniture (the) furniture of eighteenth century
-tropical birds (the) birds of the tropics
‘The’ is also used with adjectives showing nationality especially those ending in ‘ch’ or
‘sh’ e.g.
-the Dutch, the English, the French, the Spanish
‘The’ is also used with group nouns like:
-the aristocracy, the public, the administration, the government which can be used with either a
singular or a plural verb e.g.
- The audience is/are enjoying the music.
- The police never decide/decides in a hurry.
I
II
A) Institutions
bed
lie down on the bed
be in church walk past the church
go to prison drive by the prison
hospital live by the hospital
be at home, go home
be in town, leave town approach the town
282
VU
pop star.
Family Terms:
No article is used in the vocative
- hello mummy, hello daddy,
- did you thank aunty/uncle?
B. Calendar Items
a) Names of Festivals: Christmas, Eid, Independence Day, Republic Day
b) Names of the months & the days of week:
January, February, Monday, Tuesday
c) Names of seasons may have the article omitted:
… I met them in summer BUT
…. in the summer of 1945
Geographical Names
Normally there is no article whether the name is pre-modified
a)Names of continents
Exceptions: The Sahara, the Punjab, the Lebanon, the Middle East, the Ukraine, the Crimea.
c) Cities & Towns: Rome, Lahore, Karachi, Sibi
f) Public Places
-hotels & restaurants - the Moghal, the Hilton
-cinemas, clubs - the globe, the gymkhana
-museum, - the Lahore Museum,
- the British Museum
g) Magazines & periodicals normally have no article: Newsweek, Time, Punch, Mag, New
Scientist.
Practice 1:
Practice 2:
284
VU
Practice 3:
Some of the following sentences are correct, but some need the definite article. Can you
spot those that need correction?
1. Next year we are going skiing in Swiss Alps.___
2. Nile is longest river in Africa.________
3. There are many different languages spoken in Far East.______
4. They now live in the United Arab Emirates / United Arab Emirates._____
5. South of England is warmer than north.______
6. United Kingdom consists of Great Britain and Northern Ireland._____________
7. Plains of Punjab are very hot in May and June.___
8. Malta has been a republic since 1974. _______
Practice 4:
1.One of the oldest buildings in Lahore is Old Fort / the Old Fort.
2. “Which hotel are you staying at?” “At Sheraton / the Sheraton.”
3. Yesterday I opened an account at Standard Chartered Bank / the Standard Chartered
Bank.
4. Have you ever visited the University of Management Sciences / University of
Management Sciences?
5. ‘Where did you buy those shoes?’ ‘At Service’s / the Services’.
6. The President / President of United States / the United States lives in White House / the
White House.
7. “Is there a cinema hall near here?”
“Yes, Odeon / the Odeon on Montgomery Road / the Montgomery Road.
Lesson -45
Knowing a language means being able to communicate one’s ideas and opinions to others. A
foreign learner of a language may know the linguistic rules of the language he is learning - in
your case, English - but unless he or she learns to demonstrate or use this knowledge
appropriately, the learner would not be considered fully competent in the language that he / she is
learning. In today’s lesson - which is the last lesson of this course - you shall learn about
language forms & how they are used to perform functions.
What is a language function? A language function, to put it very simply, is something you want
to do with language. The primary function of language is to give factual information and convey
essential commands, feelings and emotions. Have you ever asked yourself the question what are
people trying to do when they speak? The aims of speaking involve not only broad functions
such as conveying information, expressing emotion, keeping in touch socially, and so on…, but
also more specific purposes for which language can be used, such as
Utterance Purpose
- Where the suitcase? - to get information
- Open the window - make someone
do something.
- I’ll pay you next week - make a promise.
How many language functions there are, we do not know exactly. But we do know that there are
some language functions that are regularly required for the purposes of normal everyday
communication.
To be competent in a language, the learner should know how its speakers use the language in
ways which cannot be predicted from linguistic rules alone. It means that the learner must be
aware of the various devices / structures / forms used by native speakers and writers to knit their
speech and writing into a comprehensible whole. This is done by using appropriate forms of the
language.
286
VU
If somebody expresses an opinion and you want to disagree with it, the first thought that will
come into your mind is ‘Disagree!’
The next thing you will do is to decide the language forms or structures that you will use to show
your disagreement. i.e. you will decide what grammatical structures, what vocabulary items,
what intonation patterns are to be used. There are a variety of forms to choose and use. A great
deal depends on the situation and the person you are speaking to. For instance, if the other person
is a good friend, you might say, ‘Shut up! It’s not true.”
But if it was your boss or somebody of a higher rank or status than you, you might say. ‘Excuse
me, sir / madam; you may not be quite right there.’
So when you speak who you are speaking to, will influence the language you will use.
Look at the following example:
A part of a conversation is provided. You have to see what function is being performed by the
language used by the speaker (i.e. the underlined words).
When Naila says “I think he’s marvelous,” what language function is being carried out? Is she
agreeing with Saba? Is she criticizing Junaid Jamshed? Or is she admiring him?
Because Naila’s answer is ‘I think he’s marvelous’ it means that she admires the singer. So we
can say she is admiring him. If she was criticizing him she would not have used these words of
admiration.
Now you shall have some practice, first in identifying or describing functions and second in
identifying statements which illustrate the function required.
I. Identifying Functions:
Parts of conversation / sentences are provided. Choose from the four alternatives given the one
which best describes the functions of the underlined part of the conversation.
1. Ahmed: Come on man, drive a bit faster.
Saleh: At the rate he's driving we won’t get to the airport in time, you know.
a. to express fear
b. to express anxiety
c. to express disappointment
d. to express shock.
2. Aziza: It was nice of you to invite my mother as well to your party last night.
Bibi: Not at all. It was nice to have her.
a. to express agreement.
b. to express appreciation.
c. to show sympathy
d. to give an invitation.
5. You have been regular in your payment in the past. But we notice from our records dating
from six months ago that your payment has not been received. Kindly send us your cheque
within seven days without fail.
a. to plead
b. to consent
c. to persuade
d. to instruct
6. Faraz: I hope you don’t mind my saying this but what you’ve first said is not exactly true.
a. sympathize
b. scold
c. disagree
d. surprise
7. Sara: If you want to increase the literacy rate you must educate women and girls.
Zara: I think the same as you.
a. to agree
b. to compliment
c. to reject
d. to persuade
9. Boss: The typing you’ve just done for me is hopeless. It is full of mistakes. You’ll have to do it
again.
Secretary: I’m sorry, sir.
288
VU
a. to show regret
b. to warn
c. to criticize
d. to demand
10. John: Have you heard the news? The vice principal is getting the sack.
Jane: Oh. No!
a. anger
b. sympathy
c. disbelief
d. regret
a. suggestion
b. announcement
c. request
d. welcome
B. Extended conversation
For each underlined statement or question select one response to indicate its function.
1. Father: Sajid, I don’t like your moving around with that friend of yours.
a) accuse
b) deny
c) disapprove
d) explain
5. Sajid: On drugs!
a. shock
b. admiration
c. curiosity
d. sympathy
290
VU
a. showing anxiety
b. explaining
c. asking
d. announcing
I. Response Identification:
From the four responses given choose the most appropriate which best matches the function
given.
1. Zohra: You wanted the telephone number of the girls hostel. Well, I’ve managed to
get it for you.
Jabeen: (to show gratitude)
a. I’ve already got it
b. That’s very kind of you
c. Tell me the number
d. Yes, good.
3. Mina: Would it be possible for you to return the money I lent you?
Sana: (to express regrets)
a. I’m sorry. Not till the end of the week.
b. Which money?
c. I clean forgot.
d. Sure I will.
4. Wendy: Do you think you would be able to the money by the end of this month?
Cindy: (to promise)
a. Depends when I get my salary
5. Manager: Your work is not up to the mark. You’ll have to work harder to stay in this
company.
Employee: (to express an intention)
a. How can you say that?
b. You’re biased.
c. I’m sorry I’ll try harder.
d. I do my best.
7. Aziz: I’ve just heard Abida is returning from London tomorrow morning.
Bina: (to express surprise)
a. Yes, that right. She wrote to me about it.
b. Sorry. What did you say ?
c. It’s not tomorrow but the day after.
d. No. I can’t believe it ! Tomorrow did you say?
8. Mechanic: I’ve checked your car. The engine is fine. It doesn’t need any repairs.
Car owner: (to express relief)
a. You sure?
b. Thank you.
c. Thank God for that.
d. Good old car.
292
VU
294